| \input texinfo | 
 | @setfilename ld.info | 
 | @c Copyright (C) 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | 
 | @syncodeindex ky cp | 
 | @c man begin INCLUDE | 
 | @include configdoc.texi | 
 | @c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile) | 
 | @include bfdver.texi | 
 | @c man end | 
 |  | 
 | @c @smallbook | 
 |  | 
 | @macro gcctabopt{body} | 
 | @code{\body\} | 
 | @end macro | 
 |  | 
 | @c man begin NAME | 
 | @ifset man | 
 | @c Configure for the generation of man pages | 
 | @set UsesEnvVars | 
 | @set GENERIC | 
 | @set ARM | 
 | @set C6X | 
 | @set CSKY | 
 | @set H8300 | 
 | @set HPPA | 
 | @set M68HC11 | 
 | @set M68K | 
 | @set MIPS | 
 | @set MMIX | 
 | @set MSP430 | 
 | @set NDS32 | 
 | @set NIOSII | 
 | @set PDP11 | 
 | @set POWERPC | 
 | @set POWERPC64 | 
 | @set Renesas | 
 | @set S/390 | 
 | @set SPU | 
 | @set TICOFF | 
 | @set WIN32 | 
 | @set XTENSA | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @c man end | 
 |  | 
 | @ifnottex | 
 | @dircategory Software development | 
 | @direntry | 
 | * Ld: (ld).                       The GNU linker. | 
 | @end direntry | 
 | @end ifnottex | 
 |  | 
 | @copying | 
 | This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD | 
 | @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE | 
 | @value{VERSION_PACKAGE} | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | version @value{VERSION}. | 
 |  | 
 | Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | 
 |  | 
 | Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document | 
 | under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 | 
 | or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; | 
 | with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no | 
 | Back-Cover Texts.  A copy of the license is included in the | 
 | section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''. | 
 | @end copying | 
 | @iftex | 
 | @finalout | 
 | @setchapternewpage odd | 
 | @settitle The GNU linker | 
 | @titlepage | 
 | @title The GNU linker | 
 | @sp 1 | 
 | @subtitle @code{ld} | 
 | @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE | 
 | @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE} | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @subtitle Version @value{VERSION} | 
 | @author Steve Chamberlain | 
 | @author Ian Lance Taylor | 
 | @page | 
 |  | 
 | @tex | 
 | {\parskip=0pt | 
 | \hfill Red Hat Inc\par | 
 | \hfill nickc\@redhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par | 
 | \hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par | 
 | \hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par | 
 | } | 
 | \global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way. | 
 | @end tex | 
 |  | 
 | @vskip 0pt plus 1filll | 
 | @c man begin COPYRIGHT | 
 | Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | 
 |  | 
 | Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document | 
 | under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 | 
 | or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; | 
 | with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no | 
 | Back-Cover Texts.  A copy of the license is included in the | 
 | section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''. | 
 | @c man end | 
 |  | 
 | @end titlepage | 
 | @end iftex | 
 | @contents | 
 | @c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker! | 
 |  | 
 | @ifnottex | 
 | @node Top | 
 | @top LD | 
 | This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld | 
 | @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE | 
 | @value{VERSION_PACKAGE} | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | version @value{VERSION}. | 
 |  | 
 | This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free | 
 | Documentation License version 1.3.  A copy of the license is included | 
 | in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''. | 
 |  | 
 | @menu | 
 | * Overview::                    Overview | 
 | * Invocation::                  Invocation | 
 | * Scripts::                     Linker Scripts | 
 | * Plugins::                     Linker Plugins | 
 | @ifset GENERIC | 
 | * Machine Dependent::           Machine Dependent Features | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @ifset H8300 | 
 | * H8/300::                      ld and the H8/300 | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset Renesas | 
 | * Renesas::                     ld and other Renesas micros | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset ARM | 
 | * ARM::				ld and the ARM family | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset M68HC11 | 
 | * M68HC11/68HC12::              ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset HPPA | 
 | * HPPA ELF32::                  ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset M68K | 
 | * M68K::                        ld and Motorola 68K family | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset MIPS | 
 | * MIPS::                        ld and MIPS family | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset POWERPC | 
 | * PowerPC ELF32::               ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset POWERPC64 | 
 | * PowerPC64 ELF64::             ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset S/390 | 
 | * S/390 ELF::			ld and S/390 ELF Support | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset SPU | 
 | * SPU ELF::			ld and SPU ELF Support | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset TICOFF | 
 | * TI COFF::                     ld and the TI COFF | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset WIN32 | 
 | * Win32::                       ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw) | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset XTENSA | 
 | * Xtensa::                      ld and Xtensa Processors | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @ifclear SingleFormat | 
 | * BFD::                         BFD | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus | 
 |  | 
 | * Reporting Bugs::              Reporting Bugs | 
 | * MRI::                         MRI Compatible Script Files | 
 | * GNU Free Documentation License::  GNU Free Documentation License | 
 | * LD Index::                       LD Index | 
 | @end menu | 
 | @end ifnottex | 
 |  | 
 | @node Overview | 
 | @chapter Overview | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @sc{gnu} linker | 
 | @cindex what is this? | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset man | 
 | @c man begin SYNOPSIS | 
 | ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{} | 
 | @c man end | 
 |  | 
 | @c man begin SEEALSO | 
 | ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and | 
 | the Info entries for @file{binutils} and | 
 | @file{ld}. | 
 | @c man end | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @c man begin DESCRIPTION | 
 |  | 
 | @command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates | 
 | their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in | 
 | compiling a program is to run @command{ld}. | 
 |  | 
 | @command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in | 
 | a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax, | 
 | to provide explicit and total control over the linking process. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset man | 
 | @c For the man only | 
 | This man page does not describe the command language; see the | 
 | @command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command | 
 | language and on other aspects of the GNU linker. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear SingleFormat | 
 | This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries | 
 | to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and | 
 | write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or | 
 | @code{a.out}.  Different formats may be linked together to produce any | 
 | available kind of object file.  @xref{BFD}, for more information. | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other | 
 | linkers in providing diagnostic information.  Many linkers abandon | 
 | execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible, | 
 | @command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors | 
 | (or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error). | 
 |  | 
 | @c man end | 
 |  | 
 | @node Invocation | 
 | @chapter Invocation | 
 |  | 
 | @c man begin DESCRIPTION | 
 |  | 
 | The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations, | 
 | and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers.  As a result, | 
 | you have many choices to control its behavior. | 
 |  | 
 | @c man end | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset UsesEnvVars | 
 | @menu | 
 | * Options::                     Command-line Options | 
 | * Environment::                 Environment Variables | 
 | @end menu | 
 |  | 
 | @node Options | 
 | @section Command-line Options | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex command line | 
 | @cindex options | 
 |  | 
 | @c man begin OPTIONS | 
 |  | 
 | The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual | 
 | practice few of them are used in any particular context. | 
 | @cindex standard Unix system | 
 | For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix | 
 | object files on a standard, supported Unix system.  On such a system, to | 
 | link a file @code{hello.o}: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the | 
 | result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and | 
 | the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search | 
 | directories.  (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.) | 
 |  | 
 | Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any | 
 | point in the command line.  However, options which refer to files, such | 
 | as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at | 
 | which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object | 
 | files and other file options.  Repeating non-file options with a | 
 | different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior | 
 | occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that | 
 | option.  Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are | 
 | noted in the descriptions below. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex object files | 
 | Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked | 
 | together.  They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line | 
 | options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between | 
 | an option and its argument. | 
 |  | 
 | Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can | 
 | specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R}, | 
 | and the script command language.  If @emph{no} binary input files at all | 
 | are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the | 
 | message @samp{No input files}. | 
 |  | 
 | If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will | 
 | assume that it is a linker script.  A script specified in this way | 
 | augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default | 
 | linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}).  This feature | 
 | permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object | 
 | or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses | 
 | @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects.  Specifying a | 
 | script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the | 
 | extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option | 
 | to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of | 
 | the @code{INSERT} command.  @xref{Scripts}. | 
 |  | 
 | For options whose names are a single letter, | 
 | option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening | 
 | whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the | 
 | option that requires them. | 
 |  | 
 | For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can | 
 | precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and | 
 | @samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent.  Note---there is one exception to | 
 | this rule.  Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can | 
 | only be preceded by two dashes.  This is to reduce confusion with the | 
 | @samp{-o} option.  So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file | 
 | name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the | 
 | output. | 
 |  | 
 | Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the | 
 | option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments | 
 | immediately following the option that requires them.  For example, | 
 | @samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent. | 
 | Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are | 
 | accepted. | 
 |  | 
 | Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver | 
 | (e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be | 
 | prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular | 
 | compiler driver) like this: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may | 
 | silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link.  Confusion | 
 | may also arise when passing options that require values through a | 
 | driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as | 
 | a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker | 
 | and the argument to the compiler.  In this case, it is simplest to use | 
 | the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU | 
 | linker: | 
 |  | 
 | @table @gcctabopt | 
 | @include at-file.texi | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -a @var{keyword} | 
 | @item -a @var{keyword} | 
 | This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility.  The @var{keyword} | 
 | argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or | 
 | @samp{default}.  @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to | 
 | @samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent | 
 | to @samp{-Bdynamic}.  This option may be used any number of times. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB} | 
 | @item --audit @var{AUDITLIB} | 
 | Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section. | 
 | @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME | 
 | specified in the library.  If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT} | 
 | will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker | 
 | finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries, | 
 | it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file. | 
 | This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit | 
 | interface. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear SingleFormat | 
 | @cindex binary input format | 
 | @kindex -b @var{format} | 
 | @kindex --format=@var{format} | 
 | @cindex input format | 
 | @cindex input format | 
 | @item -b @var{input-format} | 
 | @itemx --format=@var{input-format} | 
 | @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object | 
 | file.  If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the | 
 | @samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files | 
 | that follow this option on the command line.  Even when @command{ld} is | 
 | configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need | 
 | to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a | 
 | default input format the most usual format on each machine. | 
 | @var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format | 
 | supported by the BFD libraries.  (You can list the available binary | 
 | formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) | 
 | @xref{BFD}. | 
 |  | 
 | You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual | 
 | binary format.  You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when | 
 | linking object files of different formats), by including | 
 | @samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a | 
 | particular format. | 
 |  | 
 | The default format is taken from the environment variable | 
 | @code{GNUTARGET}. | 
 | @ifset UsesEnvVars | 
 | @xref{Environment}. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | You can also define the input format from a script, using the command | 
 | @code{TARGET}; | 
 | @ifclear man | 
 | see @ref{Format Commands}. | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile} | 
 | @kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile} | 
 | @cindex compatibility, MRI | 
 | @item -c @var{MRI-commandfile} | 
 | @itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile} | 
 | For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script | 
 | files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in | 
 | @ifclear man | 
 | @ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}. | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @ifset man | 
 | the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | Introduce MRI script files with | 
 | the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker | 
 | scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language. | 
 | If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories | 
 | specified by any @samp{-L} options. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex common allocation | 
 | @kindex -d | 
 | @kindex -dc | 
 | @kindex -dp | 
 | @item -d | 
 | @itemx -dc | 
 | @itemx -dp | 
 | These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for | 
 | compatibility with other linkers.  They assign space to common symbols | 
 | even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}).  The | 
 | script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect. | 
 | @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB} | 
 | @kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB} | 
 | @item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB} | 
 | @itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB} | 
 | Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section. | 
 | @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME | 
 | specified in the library.  If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} | 
 | will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use.  This | 
 | option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface. | 
 | The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --enable-linker-version | 
 | @item   --enable-linker-version | 
 | Enables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, described | 
 | in @ref{Output Section Data}.  If this directive is used in a linker | 
 | script and this option has been enabled then a string containing the | 
 | linker version will be inserted at the current point. | 
 |  | 
 | Note - this location of this option on the linker command line is | 
 | significant.  It will only affect linker scripts that come after it on | 
 | the command line, or which are built into the linker. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --disable-linker-version | 
 | @item   --disable-linker-version | 
 | Disables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, so that it | 
 | does not insert a version string.  This is the default. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions | 
 | @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions | 
 | This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not | 
 | fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input | 
 | section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an | 
 | error only if no output section is large enough.  This is useful when | 
 | several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input | 
 | section does not require a particular one.  The order in which input | 
 | sections are evaluated does not change, for instance: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   MEMORY @{ | 
 |     MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14 | 
 |     MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40 | 
 |     MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40 | 
 |   @} | 
 |   SECTIONS @{ | 
 |     mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1 | 
 |     mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2 | 
 |     mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM3 | 
 |   @} | 
 |  | 
 |   with input sections: | 
 |   .data.1: size 8 | 
 |   .data.2: size 0x10 | 
 |   .data.3: size 4 | 
 |  | 
 |   results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3 | 
 |   affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3. | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes | 
 | the way input sections are mapped to output sections. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings | 
 | @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings | 
 | This option enables warnings when | 
 | @code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected | 
 | matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently | 
 | discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any | 
 | output region. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex entry point, from command line | 
 | @kindex -e @var{entry} | 
 | @kindex --entry=@var{entry} | 
 | @item -e @var{entry} | 
 | @itemx --entry=@var{entry} | 
 | Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your | 
 | program, rather than the default entry point.  If there is no symbol | 
 | named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number, | 
 | and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in | 
 | base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading | 
 | @samp{0} for base 8).  @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults | 
 | and other ways of specifying the entry point. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --exclude-libs | 
 | @item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},... | 
 | Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically | 
 | exported.  The library names may be delimited by commas or colons.  Specifying | 
 | @code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from | 
 | automatic export.  This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted | 
 | port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports.  For i386 PE, symbols | 
 | explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this | 
 | option.  For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will | 
 | be treated as hidden. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib | 
 | @item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},... | 
 | Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols | 
 | should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale | 
 | into the import library being generated during the link.  The module names | 
 | may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames | 
 | used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply | 
 | the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and | 
 | match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's | 
 | command-line.  This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port | 
 | of the linker.  Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, | 
 | regardless of this option. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex dynamic symbol table | 
 | @kindex -E | 
 | @kindex --export-dynamic | 
 | @kindex --no-export-dynamic | 
 | @item -E | 
 | @itemx --export-dynamic | 
 | @itemx --no-export-dynamic | 
 | When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E} | 
 | option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add | 
 | all symbols to the dynamic symbol table.  The dynamic symbol table is the | 
 | set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time. | 
 |  | 
 | If you do not use either of these options (or use the | 
 | @option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the | 
 | dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are | 
 | referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link. | 
 |  | 
 | If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer | 
 | back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other | 
 | dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when | 
 | linking the program itself. | 
 |  | 
 | You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should | 
 | be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it. | 
 | See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}. | 
 |  | 
 | Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports.  PE targets | 
 | support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see | 
 | the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob} | 
 | @cindex export dynamic symbol | 
 | @item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob} | 
 | When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching | 
 | @var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a | 
 | shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be | 
 | bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a | 
 | no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or | 
 | @samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful | 
 | on ELF platforms which support shared libraries. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file} | 
 | @cindex export dynamic symbol list | 
 | @item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file} | 
 | Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file. | 
 | The format of the file is the same as the version node without | 
 | scope and node name.  See @ref{VERSION} for more information. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear SingleFormat | 
 | @cindex big-endian objects | 
 | @cindex endianness | 
 | @kindex -EB | 
 | @item -EB | 
 | Link big-endian objects.  This affects the default output format. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex little-endian objects | 
 | @kindex -EL | 
 | @item -EL | 
 | Link little-endian objects.  This affects the default output format. | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -f @var{name} | 
 | @kindex --auxiliary=@var{name} | 
 | @item -f @var{name} | 
 | @itemx --auxiliary=@var{name} | 
 | When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field | 
 | to the specified name.  This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol | 
 | table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the | 
 | symbol table of the shared object @var{name}. | 
 |  | 
 | If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you | 
 | run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field.  If | 
 | the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will | 
 | first check whether there is a definition in the shared object | 
 | @var{name}.  If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition | 
 | in the filter object.  The shared object @var{name} need not exist. | 
 | Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative | 
 | implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for | 
 | machine-specific performance. | 
 |  | 
 | This option may be specified more than once.  The DT_AUXILIARY entries | 
 | will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -F @var{name} | 
 | @kindex --filter=@var{name} | 
 | @item -F @var{name} | 
 | @itemx --filter=@var{name} | 
 | When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to | 
 | the specified name.  This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table | 
 | of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter | 
 | on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}. | 
 |  | 
 | If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you | 
 | run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field.  The | 
 | dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the | 
 | filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions | 
 | found in the shared object @var{name}.  Thus the filter object can be | 
 | used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object | 
 | @var{name}. | 
 |  | 
 | Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation | 
 | toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output | 
 | object files. | 
 | @ifclear SingleFormat | 
 | The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the | 
 | @option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the | 
 | @code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET} | 
 | environment variable. | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not | 
 | creating an ELF shared object. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex finalization function | 
 | @kindex -fini=@var{name} | 
 | @item -fini=@var{name} | 
 | When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the | 
 | executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the | 
 | address of the function.  By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as | 
 | the function to call. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -g | 
 | @item -g | 
 | Ignored.  Provided for compatibility with other tools. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -G @var{value} | 
 | @kindex --gpsize=@var{value} | 
 | @cindex object size | 
 | @item -G @var{value} | 
 | @itemx --gpsize=@var{value} | 
 | Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to | 
 | @var{size}.  This is only meaningful for object file formats such as | 
 | MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different | 
 | sections.  This is ignored for other object file formats. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex runtime library name | 
 | @kindex -h @var{name} | 
 | @kindex -soname=@var{name} | 
 | @item -h @var{name} | 
 | @itemx -soname=@var{name} | 
 | When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to | 
 | the specified name.  When an executable is linked with a shared object | 
 | which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic | 
 | linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME | 
 | field rather than using the file name given to the linker. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -i | 
 | @cindex incremental link | 
 | @item -i | 
 | Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}). | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex initialization function | 
 | @kindex -init=@var{name} | 
 | @item -init=@var{name} | 
 | When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the | 
 | executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address | 
 | of the function.  By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the | 
 | function to call. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex archive files, from cmd line | 
 | @kindex -l @var{namespec} | 
 | @kindex --library=@var{namespec} | 
 | @item -l @var{namespec} | 
 | @itemx --library=@var{namespec} | 
 | Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the | 
 | list of files to link.  This option may be used any number of times. | 
 | If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld} | 
 | will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it | 
 | will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. | 
 |  | 
 | On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for | 
 | files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.  Specifically, on ELF | 
 | and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library | 
 | called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called | 
 | @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.  (By convention, a @code{.so} extension | 
 | indicates a shared library.)  Note that this behavior does not apply | 
 | to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called | 
 | @var{filename}. | 
 |  | 
 | The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is | 
 | specified on the command line.  If the archive defines a symbol which | 
 | was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the | 
 | command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the | 
 | archive.  However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on | 
 | the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again. | 
 |  | 
 | See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search | 
 | archives multiple times. | 
 |  | 
 | You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset GENERIC | 
 | This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers.  However, | 
 | if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the | 
 | behaviour of the AIX linker. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex search directory, from cmd line | 
 | @kindex -L @var{dir} | 
 | @kindex --library-path=@var{dir} | 
 | @item -L @var{searchdir} | 
 | @itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir} | 
 | Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search | 
 | for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts.  You may use this | 
 | option any number of times.  The directories are searched in the order | 
 | in which they are specified on the command line.  Directories specified | 
 | on the command line are searched before the default directories.  All | 
 | @option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the | 
 | order in which the options appear.  @option{-L} options do not affect | 
 | how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T} | 
 | option is specified. | 
 |  | 
 | If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this | 
 | prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the | 
 | @samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset UsesEnvVars | 
 | The default set of paths searched (without being specified with | 
 | @samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in | 
 | some cases also on how it was configured.  @xref{Environment}. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | The paths can also be specified in a link script with the | 
 | @code{SEARCH_DIR} command.  Directories specified this way are searched | 
 | at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex emulation | 
 | @kindex -m @var{emulation} | 
 | @item -m @var{emulation} | 
 | Emulate the @var{emulation} linker.  You can list the available | 
 | emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. | 
 |  | 
 | If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the | 
 | @code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined. | 
 |  | 
 | Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was | 
 | configured. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex link map | 
 | @kindex -M | 
 | @kindex --print-map | 
 | @item -M | 
 | @itemx --print-map | 
 | Print a link map to the standard output.  A link map provides | 
 | information about the link, including the following: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize @bullet | 
 | @item | 
 | Where object files are mapped into memory. | 
 | @item | 
 | How common symbols are allocated. | 
 | @item | 
 | All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol | 
 | which caused the archive member to be brought in. | 
 | @item | 
 | The values assigned to symbols. | 
 |  | 
 | Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which | 
 | involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not | 
 | have correct result displayed in the link map.  This is because the | 
 | linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value | 
 | of an expression.  Under such circumstances the linker will display | 
 | the final value enclosed by square brackets.  Thus for example a | 
 | linker script containing: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |    foo = 1 | 
 |    foo = foo * 4 | 
 |    foo = foo + 8 | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M} | 
 | option is used: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |    0x00000001                foo = 0x1 | 
 |    [0x0000000c]                foo = (foo * 0x4) | 
 |    [0x0000000c]                foo = (foo + 0x8) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker | 
 | scripts. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | How GNU properties are merged. | 
 |  | 
 | When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output | 
 | .note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated. | 
 | These actions are reported in the link map.  For example: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when | 
 | merging properties in  @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value | 
 | is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output | 
 | when merging properties in  @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value | 
 | is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1. | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex link map discarded | 
 | @kindex --print-map-discarded | 
 | @kindex --no-print-map-discarded | 
 | @item --print-map-discarded | 
 | @itemx --no-print-map-discarded | 
 | Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections | 
 | in the link map.  Enabled by default. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --print-map-locals | 
 | @kindex --no-print-map-locals | 
 | @item --print-map-locals | 
 | @itemx --no-print-map-locals | 
 | Print (or do not print) local symbols in the link map.  Local symbols | 
 | will have the text @samp{(local)} printed before their name, and will | 
 | be listed after all of the global symbols in a given section. | 
 | Temporary local symbols (typically those that start with @samp{.L}) | 
 | will not be included in the output.  Disabled by default. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -n | 
 | @cindex read-only text | 
 | @cindex NMAGIC | 
 | @kindex --nmagic | 
 | @item -n | 
 | @itemx --nmagic | 
 | Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared | 
 | libraries.  If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers, | 
 | mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -N | 
 | @kindex --omagic | 
 | @cindex read/write from cmd line | 
 | @cindex OMAGIC | 
 | @item -N | 
 | @itemx --omagic | 
 | Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable.  Also, do | 
 | not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared | 
 | libraries.  If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers, | 
 | mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section | 
 | is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format | 
 | specification published by Microsoft. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-omagic | 
 | @cindex OMAGIC | 
 | @item --no-omagic | 
 | This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option.  It | 
 | sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to | 
 | be page-aligned.  Note - this option does not enable linking against | 
 | shared libraries.  Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -o @var{output} | 
 | @kindex --output=@var{output} | 
 | @cindex naming the output file | 
 | @item -o @var{output} | 
 | @itemx --output=@var{output} | 
 | Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this | 
 | option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default.  The | 
 | script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile} | 
 | @cindex dependency file | 
 | @item --dependency-file=@var{depfile} | 
 | Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}.  This file contains a rule | 
 | suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files | 
 | that were read to produce it.  The output is similar to the compiler's | 
 | output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options | 
 | Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler | 
 | Collection}).  Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM}, | 
 | to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the | 
 | linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler).  So the output from | 
 | @samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the | 
 | installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into | 
 | distributed makefiles without careful editing. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -O @var{level} | 
 | @cindex generating optimized output | 
 | @item -O @var{level} | 
 | If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes | 
 | the output.  This might take significantly longer and therefore probably | 
 | should only be enabled for the final binary.  At the moment this | 
 | option only affects ELF shared library generation.  Future releases of | 
 | the linker may make more use of this option.  Also currently there is | 
 | no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values | 
 | of this option.  Again this may change with future releases. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -plugin @var{name} | 
 | @item -plugin @var{name} | 
 | Involve a plugin in the linking process.  The @var{name} parameter is | 
 | the absolute filename of the plugin.  Usually this parameter is | 
 | automatically added by the complier, when using link time | 
 | optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so | 
 | wish. | 
 |  | 
 | Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different | 
 | from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and | 
 | @command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins.  In order for | 
 | those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be | 
 | copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory.  All gcc | 
 | based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to | 
 | just copy in the newest one. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --push-state | 
 | @cindex push state governing input file handling | 
 | @item --push-state | 
 | The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the | 
 | flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be | 
 | restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option. | 
 |  | 
 | The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic}, | 
 | @option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared}, | 
 | @option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive}, | 
 | @option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur}, | 
 | @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}, | 
 | @option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}. | 
 |  | 
 | One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}.  When | 
 | used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are | 
 | listed and then possibly linked with all the time.  It is better to return | 
 | something as follows: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --pop-state | 
 | @cindex pop state governing input file handling | 
 | @item --pop-state | 
 | Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the | 
 | flags governing input file handling. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -q | 
 | @kindex --emit-relocs | 
 | @cindex retain relocations in final executable | 
 | @item -q | 
 | @itemx --emit-relocs | 
 | Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables. | 
 | Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in | 
 | order to perform correct modifications of executables.  This results | 
 | in larger executables. | 
 |  | 
 | This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --force-dynamic | 
 | @cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections | 
 | @item --force-dynamic | 
 | Force the output file to have dynamic sections.  This option is specific | 
 | to VxWorks targets. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex partial link | 
 | @cindex relocatable output | 
 | @kindex -r | 
 | @kindex --relocatable | 
 | @item -r | 
 | @itemx --relocatable | 
 | Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in | 
 | turn serve as input to @command{ld}.  This is often called @dfn{partial | 
 | linking}.  As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix | 
 | magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to | 
 | @code{OMAGIC}. | 
 | @c ; see @option{-N}. | 
 | If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced.  When | 
 | linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to | 
 | constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}. | 
 |  | 
 | When an input file does not have the same format as the output file, | 
 | partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any | 
 | relocations.  Different output formats can have further restrictions; for | 
 | example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking | 
 | with input files in other formats at all. | 
 |  | 
 | This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -R @var{file} | 
 | @kindex --just-symbols=@var{file} | 
 | @cindex symbol-only input | 
 | @item -R @var{filename} | 
 | @itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename} | 
 | Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not | 
 | relocate it or include it in the output.  This allows your output file | 
 | to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other | 
 | programs.  You may use this option more than once. | 
 |  | 
 | For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is | 
 | followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as | 
 | the @option{-rpath} option. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -s | 
 | @kindex --strip-all | 
 | @cindex strip all symbols | 
 | @item -s | 
 | @itemx --strip-all | 
 | Omit all symbol information from the output file. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -S | 
 | @kindex --strip-debug | 
 | @cindex strip debugger symbols | 
 | @item -S | 
 | @itemx --strip-debug | 
 | Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --strip-discarded | 
 | @kindex --no-strip-discarded | 
 | @item --strip-discarded | 
 | @itemx --no-strip-discarded | 
 | Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections. | 
 | Enabled by default. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -t | 
 | @kindex --trace | 
 | @cindex input files, displaying | 
 | @item -t | 
 | @itemx --trace | 
 | Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them.  If | 
 | @samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed. | 
 | @samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files | 
 | and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for | 
 | a linker bug report. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -T @var{script} | 
 | @kindex --script=@var{script} | 
 | @cindex script files | 
 | @item -T @var{scriptfile} | 
 | @itemx --script=@var{scriptfile} | 
 | Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script.  This script replaces | 
 | @command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), | 
 | unless the script contains @code{INSERT}, so | 
 | @var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the | 
 | output file.  @xref{Scripts}.  If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in | 
 | the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories | 
 | specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options.  Multiple @samp{-T} | 
 | options accumulate. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -dT @var{script} | 
 | @kindex --default-script=@var{script} | 
 | @cindex script files | 
 | @item -dT @var{scriptfile} | 
 | @itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile} | 
 | Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script.  @xref{Scripts}. | 
 |  | 
 | This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that | 
 | processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the | 
 | command line has been processed.  This allows options placed after the | 
 | @option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the | 
 | behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker | 
 | command line cannot be directly controlled by the user.  (eg because | 
 | the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as | 
 | @samp{gcc}). | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -u @var{symbol} | 
 | @kindex --undefined=@var{symbol} | 
 | @cindex undefined symbol | 
 | @item -u @var{symbol} | 
 | @itemx --undefined=@var{symbol} | 
 | Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined | 
 | symbol.  Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional | 
 | modules from standard libraries.  @samp{-u} may be repeated with | 
 | different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols.  This | 
 | option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command. | 
 |  | 
 | If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled | 
 | into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain | 
 | undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used | 
 | instead. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol} | 
 | @cindex symbols, require defined | 
 | @cindex defined symbol | 
 | @item --require-defined=@var{symbol} | 
 | Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file.  This option | 
 | is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol} | 
 | is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error | 
 | and exit.  The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using | 
 | @code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together.  This option | 
 | can be used multiple times to require additional symbols. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Ur | 
 | @cindex constructors | 
 | @item -Ur | 
 |  | 
 | For programs that do not use constructors or destructors, or for ELF | 
 | based systems this option is equivalent to @option{-r}:  it generates | 
 | relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in turn serve as | 
 | input to @command{ld}.  For other binaries however the @option{-Ur} | 
 | option is similar to @option{-r} but it also resolves references to | 
 | constructors and destructors. | 
 |  | 
 | For those systems where @option{-r} and @option{-Ur} behave | 
 | differently, it does not work to use @option{-Ur} on files that were | 
 | themselves linked with @option{-Ur}; once the constructor table has | 
 | been built, it cannot be added to.  Use @option{-Ur} only for the last | 
 | partial link, and @option{-r} for the others. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE} | 
 | @cindex orphan sections | 
 | @cindex sections, orphan | 
 | @item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE} | 
 | Control how orphan sections are handled.  An orphan section is one not | 
 | specifically mentioned in a linker script.  @xref{Orphan Sections}. | 
 |  | 
 | @var{MODE} can have any of the following values: | 
 |  | 
 | @table @code | 
 | @item place | 
 | Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following | 
 | the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}.  The option | 
 | @samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed. | 
 |  | 
 | @item discard | 
 | All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the | 
 | @samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}). | 
 |  | 
 | @item warn | 
 | The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also | 
 | issue a warning. | 
 |  | 
 | @item error | 
 | The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}] | 
 | @item --unique[=@var{SECTION}] | 
 | Creates a separate output section for every input section matching | 
 | @var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is | 
 | missing, for every orphan input section.  An orphan section is one not | 
 | specifically mentioned in a linker script.  You may use this option | 
 | multiple times on the command line;  It prevents the normal merging of | 
 | input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments | 
 | in a linker script. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -v | 
 | @kindex -V | 
 | @kindex --version | 
 | @cindex version | 
 | @item -v | 
 | @itemx --version | 
 | @itemx -V | 
 | Display the version number for @command{ld}.  The @option{-V} option also | 
 | lists the supported emulations.  See also the description of the | 
 | @option{--enable-linker-version} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} | 
 | which can be used to insert the linker version string into a binary. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -x | 
 | @kindex --discard-all | 
 | @cindex deleting local symbols | 
 | @item -x | 
 | @itemx --discard-all | 
 | Delete all local symbols. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -X | 
 | @kindex --discard-locals | 
 | @cindex local symbols, deleting | 
 | @item -X | 
 | @itemx --discard-locals | 
 | Delete all temporary local symbols.  (These symbols start with | 
 | system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems | 
 | or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.) | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -y @var{symbol} | 
 | @kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol} | 
 | @cindex symbol tracing | 
 | @item -y @var{symbol} | 
 | @itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol} | 
 | Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears.  This | 
 | option may be given any number of times.  On many systems it is necessary | 
 | to prepend an underscore. | 
 |  | 
 | This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but | 
 | don't know where the reference is coming from. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Y @var{path} | 
 | @item -Y @var{path} | 
 | Add @var{path} to the default library search path.  This option exists | 
 | for Solaris compatibility. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -z @var{keyword} | 
 | @item -z @var{keyword} | 
 | The recognized keywords are: | 
 | @table @samp | 
 |  | 
 | @item call-nop=prefix-addr | 
 | @itemx call-nop=suffix-nop | 
 | @itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte} | 
 | @itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte} | 
 | Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call | 
 | to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot. | 
 | @option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}. | 
 | @option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}. | 
 | @option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}. | 
 | @option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}. | 
 | Supported for i386 and x86_64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item cet-report=none | 
 | @itemx cet-report=warning | 
 | @itemx cet-report=error | 
 | Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and | 
 | GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property | 
 | section.  @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the | 
 | linker not report missing properties in input files. | 
 | @option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for | 
 | missing properties in input files.  @option{cet-report=error} will make | 
 | the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files. | 
 | Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing | 
 | GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will | 
 | turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report. | 
 | Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item combreloc | 
 | @itemx nocombreloc | 
 | Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve | 
 | dynamic symbol lookup caching.  Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item common | 
 | @itemx nocommon | 
 | Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable | 
 | link.  Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item common-page-size=@var{value} | 
 | Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}.  Memory image | 
 | layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is | 
 | using pages of this size. | 
 |  | 
 | @item defs | 
 | Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files.  This | 
 | is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library. | 
 | This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item dynamic-undefined-weak | 
 | @itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak | 
 | Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object, | 
 | if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local | 
 | by symbol visibility or versioning.  Do not make them dynamic if | 
 | @samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}.  If neither option is given, a target | 
 | may default to either option being in force, or make some other | 
 | selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic.  Not all targets support | 
 | these options. | 
 |  | 
 | @item execstack | 
 | Marks the object as requiring executable stack. | 
 |  | 
 | @item global | 
 | This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.  It makes | 
 | the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution | 
 | of subsequently loaded libraries. | 
 |  | 
 | @item globalaudit | 
 | This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable. | 
 | This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by | 
 | setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic | 
 | tag.  Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via | 
 | the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for | 
 | all dynamic objects loaded by the application. | 
 |  | 
 | @item ibtplt | 
 | Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries. | 
 | Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item ibt | 
 | Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section | 
 | to indicate compatibility with IBT.  This also implies @option{ibtplt}. | 
 | Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item indirect-extern-access | 
 | @itemx noindirect-extern-access | 
 | Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in | 
 | .note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires | 
 | canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation. | 
 | This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and | 
 | @option{nocopyreloc}.  Supported for i386 and x86-64. | 
 |  | 
 | @option{noindirect-extern-access} removes | 
 | GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property | 
 | section. | 
 |  | 
 | @item initfirst | 
 | This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. | 
 | It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur | 
 | before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into | 
 | the process at the same time.  Similarly the runtime finalization of | 
 | the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other | 
 | objects. | 
 |  | 
 | @item interpose | 
 | Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order | 
 | so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared | 
 | libraries not so marked. | 
 |  | 
 | @item unique | 
 | @itemx nounique | 
 | When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF | 
 | object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once, | 
 | and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is | 
 | primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et | 
 | al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances | 
 | of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller | 
 | and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries). | 
 |  | 
 | @item lam-u48 | 
 | Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section | 
 | to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48.  Supported for Linux/x86_64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item lam-u57 | 
 | Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section | 
 | to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57.  Supported for Linux/x86_64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item lam-u48-report=none | 
 | @itemx lam-u48-report=warning | 
 | @itemx lam-u48-report=error | 
 | Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 | 
 | property in input .note.gnu.property section. | 
 | @option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the | 
 | linker not report missing properties in input files. | 
 | @option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for | 
 | missing properties in input files.  @option{lam-u48-report=error} will | 
 | make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files. | 
 | Supported for Linux/x86_64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item lam-u57-report=none | 
 | @itemx lam-u57-report=warning | 
 | @itemx lam-u57-report=error | 
 | Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 | 
 | property in input .note.gnu.property section. | 
 | @option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the | 
 | linker not report missing properties in input files. | 
 | @option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for | 
 | missing properties in input files.  @option{lam-u57-report=error} will | 
 | make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files. | 
 | Supported for Linux/x86_64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item lam-report=none | 
 | @itemx lam-report=warning | 
 | @itemx lam-report=error | 
 | Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and | 
 | GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property | 
 | section.  @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the | 
 | linker not report missing properties in input files. | 
 | @option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for | 
 | missing properties in input files.  @option{lam-report=error} will make | 
 | the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files. | 
 | Supported for Linux/x86_64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item lazy | 
 | When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the | 
 | dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when | 
 | the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time. | 
 | Lazy binding is the default. | 
 |  | 
 | @item loadfltr | 
 | Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime. | 
 |  | 
 | @item max-page-size=@var{value} | 
 | Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item muldefs | 
 | Allow multiple definitions. | 
 |  | 
 | @item nocopyreloc | 
 | Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables | 
 | defined in shared libraries.  May result in dynamic text relocations. | 
 |  | 
 | @item nodefaultlib | 
 | Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object | 
 | should ignore any default library search paths. | 
 |  | 
 | @item nodelete | 
 | Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime. | 
 |  | 
 | @item nodlopen | 
 | Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item nodump | 
 | Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item noexecstack | 
 | Marks the object as not requiring executable stack. | 
 |  | 
 | @item noextern-protected-data | 
 | Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared | 
 | library.  This option overrides the linker backend default.  It can be | 
 | used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols | 
 | generated by compiler.  Updates on protected data symbols by another | 
 | module aren't visible to the resulting shared library.  Supported for | 
 | i386 and x86-64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item noreloc-overflow | 
 | Disable relocation overflow check.  This can be used to disable | 
 | relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation | 
 | overflow at run-time.  Supported for x86_64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item now | 
 | When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the | 
 | dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or | 
 | when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring | 
 | function call resolution to the point when the function is first | 
 | called. | 
 |  | 
 | @item origin | 
 | Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths. | 
 |  | 
 | @item pack-relative-relocs | 
 | @itemx nopack-relative-relocs | 
 | Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable | 
 | and shared library.  It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and | 
 | @code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section.  It is ignored when | 
 | building position-dependent executable and relocatable output. | 
 | @option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact | 
 | relative relocation.  When linked against the GNU C Library, a | 
 | GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is | 
 | added to the output.  Supported for i386 and x86-64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item relro | 
 | @itemx norelro | 
 | Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object.  This | 
 | specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after | 
 | relocation, if supported.  Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller | 
 | than the system page size will render this protection ineffective. | 
 | Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item report-relative-reloc | 
 | Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker.  Supported for | 
 | Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item separate-code | 
 | @itemx noseparate-code | 
 | Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object.  This | 
 | specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must | 
 | be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data.  Don't create separate | 
 | code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used. | 
 |  | 
 | @item shstk | 
 | Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section | 
 | to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack.  Supported for | 
 | Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64. | 
 |  | 
 | @item stack-size=@var{value} | 
 | Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment. | 
 | Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized | 
 | @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation. | 
 |  | 
 | @item start-stop-gc | 
 | @itemx nostart-stop-gc | 
 | @cindex start-stop-gc | 
 | When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained | 
 | section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all | 
 | input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if | 
 | @code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either | 
 | @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the | 
 | linker.  @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing | 
 | sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols | 
 | were not defined.  @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a | 
 | definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an | 
 | object file or linker script.  Such a definition will prevent the | 
 | linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or | 
 | @code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special | 
 | treatment by garbage collection for those references. | 
 |  | 
 | @item start-stop-visibility=@var{value} | 
 | @cindex visibility | 
 | @cindex ELF symbol visibility | 
 | Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized | 
 | @code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input | 
 | Section Example}).  @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default}, | 
 | @samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}.  If no @samp{-z | 
 | start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for | 
 | compatibility with historical practice.  However, it's highly | 
 | recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new | 
 | programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported | 
 | between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended. | 
 |  | 
 | @item text | 
 | @itemx notext | 
 | @itemx textoff | 
 | Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent | 
 | or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections.  Don't | 
 | report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item undefs | 
 | Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files, | 
 | either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library. | 
 | This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item unique-symbol | 
 | @itemx nounique-symbol | 
 | Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table.  Append | 
 | ".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol} | 
 | is used.  @option{nounique-symbol} is the default. | 
 |  | 
 | @item x86-64-baseline | 
 | @item x86-64-v2 | 
 | @item x86-64-v3 | 
 | @itemx x86-64-v4 | 
 | Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section. | 
 | @option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}. | 
 | @option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}. | 
 | @option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}. | 
 | @option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}. | 
 | Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64. | 
 |  | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -( | 
 | @cindex groups of archives | 
 | @item -( @var{archives} -) | 
 | @itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group | 
 | The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files.  They may be | 
 | either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options. | 
 |  | 
 | The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined | 
 | references are created.  Normally, an archive is searched only once in | 
 | the order that it is specified on the command line.  If a symbol in that | 
 | archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an | 
 | object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker | 
 | would not be able to resolve that reference.  By grouping the archives, | 
 | they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are | 
 | resolved. | 
 |  | 
 | Using this option has a significant performance cost.  It is best to use | 
 | it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or | 
 | more archives. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch | 
 | @kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch | 
 | @item --accept-unknown-input-arch | 
 | @itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch | 
 | Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be | 
 | recognised.  The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing | 
 | and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files.  This was | 
 | the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14.  The default | 
 | behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and | 
 | so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to | 
 | restore the old behaviour. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --as-needed | 
 | @kindex --no-as-needed | 
 | @item --as-needed | 
 | @itemx --no-as-needed | 
 | This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned | 
 | on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option.  Normally | 
 | the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned | 
 | on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually | 
 | needed or not.  @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be | 
 | emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a | 
 | non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if | 
 | the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a | 
 | non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library. | 
 | Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after} | 
 | the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as | 
 | needed.  This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files | 
 | from archives.  @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour. | 
 |  | 
 | Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has | 
 | an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and | 
 | @option{--rpath-link} options.  See the description of | 
 | @option{--rpath-link} for more details. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --add-needed | 
 | @kindex --no-add-needed | 
 | @item --add-needed | 
 | @itemx --no-add-needed | 
 | These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of | 
 | their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed} | 
 | options.  They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} | 
 | and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -assert @var{keyword} | 
 | @item -assert @var{keyword} | 
 | This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Bdynamic | 
 | @kindex -dy | 
 | @kindex -call_shared | 
 | @item -Bdynamic | 
 | @itemx -dy | 
 | @itemx -call_shared | 
 | Link against dynamic libraries.  This is only meaningful on platforms | 
 | for which shared libraries are supported.  This option is normally the | 
 | default on such platforms.  The different variants of this option are | 
 | for compatibility with various systems.  You may use this option | 
 | multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for | 
 | @option{-l} options which follow it. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Bgroup | 
 | @item -Bgroup | 
 | Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic | 
 | section.  This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this | 
 | object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group. | 
 | @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied.  This option is | 
 | only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Bstatic | 
 | @kindex -dn | 
 | @kindex -non_shared | 
 | @kindex -static | 
 | @item -Bstatic | 
 | @itemx -dn | 
 | @itemx -non_shared | 
 | @itemx -static | 
 | Do not link against shared libraries.  This is only meaningful on | 
 | platforms for which shared libraries are supported.  The different | 
 | variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems.  You | 
 | may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects | 
 | library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it.  This | 
 | option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}.  This | 
 | option can be used with @option{-shared}.  Doing so means that a | 
 | shared library is being created but that all of the library's external | 
 | references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static | 
 | libraries. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Bsymbolic | 
 | @item -Bsymbolic | 
 | When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the | 
 | definition within the shared library, if any.  Normally, it is possible | 
 | for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition | 
 | within the shared library.  This option is only meaningful on ELF | 
 | platforms which support shared libraries. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Bsymbolic-functions | 
 | @item -Bsymbolic-functions | 
 | When creating a shared library, bind references to global function | 
 | symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any. | 
 | This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared | 
 | libraries. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Bno-symbolic | 
 | @item -Bno-symbolic | 
 | This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and | 
 | @samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file} | 
 | @item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file} | 
 | Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker.  This is | 
 | typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of | 
 | global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition | 
 | within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables | 
 | to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table | 
 | in the executable.  This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms | 
 | which support shared libraries. | 
 |  | 
 | The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without | 
 | scope and node name.  See @ref{VERSION} for more information. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --dynamic-list-data | 
 | @item --dynamic-list-data | 
 | Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new | 
 | @item --dynamic-list-cpp-new | 
 | Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete.  It | 
 | is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo | 
 | @item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo | 
 | Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --check-sections | 
 | @kindex --no-check-sections | 
 | @item --check-sections | 
 | @itemx --no-check-sections | 
 | Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have | 
 | been assigned to see if there are any overlaps.  Normally the linker will | 
 | perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce | 
 | suitable error messages.  The linker does know about, and does make | 
 | allowances for sections in overlays.  The default behaviour can be | 
 | restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}. | 
 | Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links.  You can | 
 | force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections} | 
 | option. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries | 
 | @kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries | 
 | @item --copy-dt-needed-entries | 
 | @itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries | 
 | This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to | 
 | by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the | 
 | command line.  Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the | 
 | output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an | 
 | input dynamic library.  With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} | 
 | specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that | 
 | follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added.  The default | 
 | behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}. | 
 |  | 
 | This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic | 
 | libraries.  With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries | 
 | mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following | 
 | their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols | 
 | required by the output binary.  With the default setting however | 
 | the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the | 
 | dynamic library itself.  No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve | 
 | symbols. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex cross reference table | 
 | @kindex --cref | 
 | @item --cref | 
 | Output a cross reference table.  If a linker map file is being | 
 | generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file. | 
 | Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output. | 
 |  | 
 | The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be | 
 | easily processed by a script if necessary.  The symbols are printed out, | 
 | sorted by name.  For each symbol, a list of file names is given.  If the | 
 | symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the | 
 | definition.  If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files | 
 | where this happens appear next.  Finally any files that reference the | 
 | symbol are listed. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex ctf variables | 
 | @kindex --ctf-variables | 
 | @kindex --no-ctf-variables | 
 | @item --ctf-variables | 
 | @item --no-ctf-variables | 
 | The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and | 
 | types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol | 
 | table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by | 
 | conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is | 
 | usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not. | 
 | @option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section. | 
 | The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex ctf type sharing | 
 | @kindex --ctf-share-types | 
 | @item --ctf-share-types=@var{method} | 
 | Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @samp | 
 | @item share-unconflicted | 
 | Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary, | 
 | where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one | 
 | translation unit.  This is the default. | 
 |  | 
 | @item share-duplicated | 
 | Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared | 
 | dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit | 
 | dictionaries.  Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units | 
 | always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries.  This tends to make the CTF | 
 | larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary.  For very | 
 | large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF | 
 | consumer at runtime. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex common allocation | 
 | @kindex --no-define-common | 
 | @item --no-define-common | 
 | This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols. | 
 | The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect. | 
 | @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}. | 
 |  | 
 | The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling | 
 | the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice | 
 | of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type | 
 | forces assigning addresses to Common symbols. | 
 | Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced | 
 | from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program. | 
 | This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library, | 
 | and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong | 
 | duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search | 
 | paths for runtime symbol resolution. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex group allocation in linker script | 
 | @cindex section groups | 
 | @cindex COMDAT | 
 | @kindex --force-group-allocation | 
 | @item --force-group-allocation | 
 | This option causes the linker to place section group members like | 
 | normal input sections, and to delete the section groups.  This is the | 
 | default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to | 
 | change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}).  The script | 
 | command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same | 
 | effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex symbols, from command line | 
 | @kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp} | 
 | @item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression} | 
 | Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute | 
 | address given by @var{expression}.  You may use this option as many | 
 | times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line.  A | 
 | limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this | 
 | context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing | 
 | symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal | 
 | constants or symbols.  If you need more elaborate expressions, consider | 
 | using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}). | 
 | @emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the | 
 | equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}. | 
 |  | 
 | The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments | 
 | in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the | 
 | symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while | 
 | placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after | 
 | the linker script has been processed.  This difference has | 
 | consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the | 
 | @samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what | 
 | you are trying to achieve. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex demangling, from command line | 
 | @kindex --demangle[=@var{style}] | 
 | @kindex --no-demangle | 
 | @item --demangle[=@var{style}] | 
 | @itemx --no-demangle | 
 | These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages | 
 | and other output.  When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to | 
 | present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading | 
 | underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++ | 
 | mangled symbol names into user readable names.  Different compilers have | 
 | different mangling styles.  The optional demangling style argument can be used | 
 | to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler.  The linker will | 
 | demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} | 
 | is set.  These options may be used to override the default. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex dynamic linker, from command line | 
 | @kindex -I@var{file} | 
 | @kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file} | 
 | @item -I@var{file} | 
 | @itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file} | 
 | Set the name of the dynamic linker.  This is only meaningful when | 
 | generating dynamically linked ELF executables.  The default dynamic | 
 | linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are | 
 | doing. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-dynamic-linker | 
 | @item --no-dynamic-linker | 
 | When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic | 
 | linker to be used at load-time.  This is only meaningful for ELF | 
 | executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires | 
 | entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --embedded-relocs | 
 | @item --embedded-relocs | 
 | This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except | 
 | that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section.  This option | 
 | is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K} | 
 | targets. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs | 
 | @item --disable-multiple-abs-defs | 
 | Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included | 
 | in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --fatal-warnings | 
 | @kindex --no-fatal-warnings | 
 | @item --fatal-warnings | 
 | @itemx --no-fatal-warnings | 
 | Treat all warnings as errors.  The default behaviour can be restored | 
 | with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -w | 
 | @kindex --no-warnings | 
 | @item -w | 
 | @itemx --no-warnings | 
 | Do not display any warning or error messages.  This overrides | 
 | @option{--fatal-warnings} if it has been enabled.  This option can be | 
 | used when it is known that the output binary will not work, but there | 
 | is still a need to create it. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --force-exe-suffix | 
 | @item  --force-exe-suffix | 
 | Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix. | 
 |  | 
 | If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a | 
 | @code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy | 
 | the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This | 
 | option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft | 
 | Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless | 
 | it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --gc-sections | 
 | @kindex --no-gc-sections | 
 | @cindex garbage collection | 
 | @item --gc-sections | 
 | @itemx --no-gc-sections | 
 | Enable garbage collection of unused input sections.  It is ignored on | 
 | targets that do not support this option.  The default behaviour (of not | 
 | performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying | 
 | @samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line.  Note that garbage | 
 | collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the | 
 | implementation is currently considered to be experimental. | 
 |  | 
 | @samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by | 
 | examining symbols and relocations.  The section containing the entry | 
 | symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the | 
 | command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols | 
 | referenced by dynamic objects.  Note that when building shared | 
 | libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is | 
 | referenced.  Once this initial set of sections has been determined, | 
 | the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their | 
 | relocations.  See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and | 
 | @samp{--gc-keep-exported}. | 
 |  | 
 | This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option | 
 | @samp{-r}).  In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly | 
 | specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry}, | 
 | @samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY} | 
 | command in the linker script. | 
 |  | 
 | As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the | 
 | @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --print-gc-sections | 
 | @kindex --no-print-gc-sections | 
 | @cindex garbage collection | 
 | @item --print-gc-sections | 
 | @itemx --no-print-gc-sections | 
 | List all sections removed by garbage collection.  The listing is | 
 | printed on stderr.  This option is only effective if garbage | 
 | collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option.  The | 
 | default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can | 
 | be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command | 
 | line. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --gc-keep-exported | 
 | @cindex garbage collection | 
 | @item --gc-keep-exported | 
 | When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage | 
 | collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having | 
 | default or protected visibility.  This option is intended to be used for | 
 | executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage | 
 | collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols. | 
 | Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since | 
 | it is already the default behaviour.  This option is only supported for | 
 | ELF format targets. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --print-output-format | 
 | @cindex output format | 
 | @item --print-output-format | 
 | Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by | 
 | other command-line options).  This is the string that would appear | 
 | in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}). | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --print-memory-usage | 
 | @cindex memory usage | 
 | @item --print-memory-usage | 
 | Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with | 
 | the @ref{MEMORY} command.  This is useful on embedded targets to have a | 
 | quick view of amount of free memory.  The format of the output has one | 
 | headline and one line per region.  It is both human readable and easily | 
 | parsable by tools.  Here is an example of an output: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | Memory region         Used Size  Region Size  %age Used | 
 |              ROM:        256 KB         1 MB     25.00% | 
 |              RAM:          32 B         2 GB      0.00% | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex help | 
 | @cindex usage | 
 | @kindex --help | 
 | @item --help | 
 | Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --target-help | 
 | @item --target-help | 
 | Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Map=@var{mapfile} | 
 | @item -Map=@var{mapfile} | 
 | Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}.  See the description of the | 
 | @option{-M} option, above.  If @var{mapfile} is just the character | 
 | @code{-} then the map will be written to stdout. | 
 |  | 
 | Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be | 
 | written as a file inside the directory.  Normally name of the file | 
 | inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output} | 
 | file with @code{.map} appended.   If however the special character | 
 | @code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the | 
 | output file.  Additionally if there are any characters after the | 
 | @var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |  -o foo.exe -Map=bar                  [Creates ./bar] | 
 |  -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar           [Creates ./bar] | 
 |  -o foo.exe -Map=../dir               [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map] | 
 |  -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir       [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map] | 
 |  -o foo.exe -Map=%                    [Creates ./foo.exe.map] | 
 |  -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%             [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map] | 
 |  -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar                [Creates ./foo.exe.bar] | 
 |  -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar         [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar] | 
 |  -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%     [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map] | 
 |  -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar] | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character. | 
 |  | 
 | If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this | 
 | operation. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex memory usage | 
 | @kindex --no-keep-memory | 
 | @item --no-keep-memory | 
 | @command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the | 
 | symbol tables of input files in memory.  This option tells @command{ld} to | 
 | instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as | 
 | necessary.  This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space | 
 | while linking a large executable. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-undefined | 
 | @kindex -z defs | 
 | @kindex -z undefs | 
 | @item --no-undefined | 
 | @itemx -z defs | 
 | Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files.  This | 
 | is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library. | 
 | The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the | 
 | behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared | 
 | libraries being linked in. | 
 |  | 
 | The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --allow-multiple-definition | 
 | @kindex -z muldefs | 
 | @item --allow-multiple-definition | 
 | @itemx -z muldefs | 
 | Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will | 
 | report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the | 
 | first definition will be used. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --allow-shlib-undefined | 
 | @kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined | 
 | @item --allow-shlib-undefined | 
 | @itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined | 
 | Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries. | 
 | This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it | 
 | determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a | 
 | shared library rather than a regular object file.  It does not affect | 
 | how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled. | 
 |  | 
 | The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols | 
 | referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create | 
 | an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create | 
 | a shared library. | 
 |  | 
 | The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared | 
 | libraries specified at link time are that: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize @bullet | 
 | @item | 
 | A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one | 
 | that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be | 
 | resolvable at load time. | 
 | @item | 
 | There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined | 
 | symbols in shared libraries are normal. | 
 |  | 
 | The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to | 
 | select whichever function is most appropriate for the current | 
 | architecture.  This is used, for example, to dynamically select an | 
 | appropriate memset function. | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname} | 
 | @item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname} | 
 | If this option is provided then the linker will invoke | 
 | @var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered.  Currently however | 
 | only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing | 
 | libraries.  Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword | 
 | ``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the | 
 | undefined symbol or missing library.  The intention is that the script | 
 | will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library | 
 | might be found.  After the script has finished then the normal linker | 
 | error message will be displayed. | 
 |  | 
 | The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time | 
 | switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-undefined-version | 
 | @item --no-undefined-version | 
 | Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore | 
 | it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error | 
 | will be issued instead. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --default-symver | 
 | @item --default-symver | 
 | Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned | 
 | exported symbols. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --default-imported-symver | 
 | @item --default-imported-symver | 
 | Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned | 
 | imported symbols. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-warn-mismatch | 
 | @item --no-warn-mismatch | 
 | Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input | 
 | files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have | 
 | been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses. | 
 | This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible | 
 | errors.  This option should only be used with care, in cases when you | 
 | have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are | 
 | inappropriate. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch | 
 | @item --no-warn-search-mismatch | 
 | Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible | 
 | library during a library search.  This option silences the warning. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-whole-archive | 
 | @item --no-whole-archive | 
 | Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent | 
 | archive files. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex output file after errors | 
 | @kindex --noinhibit-exec | 
 | @item --noinhibit-exec | 
 | Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable. | 
 | Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters | 
 | errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file | 
 | when it issues any error whatsoever. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -nostdlib | 
 | @item -nostdlib | 
 | Only search library directories explicitly specified on the | 
 | command line.  Library directories specified in linker scripts | 
 | (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear SingleFormat | 
 | @kindex --oformat=@var{output-format} | 
 | @item --oformat=@var{output-format} | 
 | @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object | 
 | file.  If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the | 
 | @samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output | 
 | object file.  Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative | 
 | object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld} | 
 | should be configured to produce as a default output format the most | 
 | usual format on each machine.  @var{output-format} is a text string, the | 
 | name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries.  (You can | 
 | list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)  The script | 
 | command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but | 
 | this option overrides it.  @xref{BFD}. | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --out-implib | 
 | @item --out-implib @var{file} | 
 | Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable | 
 | the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program).  This import | 
 | library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs) | 
 | may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this | 
 | behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation | 
 | step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs).  This option is only available for | 
 | the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -pie | 
 | @kindex --pic-executable | 
 | @item -pie | 
 | @itemx --pic-executable | 
 | @cindex position independent executables | 
 | Create a position independent executable.  This is currently only supported on | 
 | ELF platforms.  Position independent executables are similar to shared | 
 | libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual | 
 | address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations).  Like | 
 | normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols | 
 | defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -no-pie | 
 | @item -no-pie | 
 | @cindex position dependent executables | 
 | Create a position dependent executable.  This is the default. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -qmagic | 
 | @item -qmagic | 
 | This option is ignored for Linux compatibility. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Qy | 
 | @item -Qy | 
 | This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --relax | 
 | @cindex synthesizing linker | 
 | @cindex relaxing addressing modes | 
 | @cindex --no-relax | 
 | @item --relax | 
 | @itemx --no-relax | 
 | An option with machine dependent effects. | 
 | @ifset GENERIC | 
 | This option is only supported on a few targets. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset H8300 | 
 | @xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset XTENSA | 
 | @xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset M68HC11 | 
 | @xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset NIOSII | 
 | @xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset POWERPC | 
 | @xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific, | 
 | global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves | 
 | addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes, | 
 | synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current | 
 | instructions, and combining constant values. | 
 |  | 
 | On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic | 
 | debugging of the resulting executable impossible. | 
 | @ifset GENERIC | 
 | This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300 | 
 | family of processors. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | On platforms where the feature is supported, the option | 
 | @option{--no-relax} will disable it. | 
 |  | 
 | On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax} | 
 | and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex retaining specified symbols | 
 | @cindex stripping all but some symbols | 
 | @cindex symbols, retaining selectively | 
 | @kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename} | 
 | @item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename} | 
 | Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename}, | 
 | discarding all others.  @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one | 
 | symbol name per line.  This option is especially useful in environments | 
 | @ifset GENERIC | 
 | (such as VxWorks) | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve | 
 | run-time memory. | 
 |  | 
 | @samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols, | 
 | or symbols needed for relocations. | 
 |  | 
 | You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command | 
 | line.  It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset GENERIC | 
 | @item -rpath=@var{dir} | 
 | @cindex runtime library search path | 
 | @kindex -rpath=@var{dir} | 
 | Add a directory to the runtime library search path.  This is used when | 
 | linking an ELF executable with shared objects.  All @option{-rpath} | 
 | arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses | 
 | them to locate shared objects at runtime. | 
 |  | 
 | The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which | 
 | are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the | 
 | description of the @option{-rpath-link} option.  Searching @option{-rpath} | 
 | in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which | 
 | have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option. | 
 |  | 
 | If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the | 
 | contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it | 
 | is defined. | 
 |  | 
 | The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS.  By default, on | 
 | SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the | 
 | @option{-L} options it is given.  If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the | 
 | runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath} | 
 | options, ignoring the @option{-L} options.  This can be useful when using | 
 | gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted | 
 | file systems. | 
 |  | 
 | For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is | 
 | followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as | 
 | the @option{-rpath} option. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset GENERIC | 
 | @cindex link-time runtime library search path | 
 | @kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir} | 
 | @item -rpath-link=@var{dir} | 
 | When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another.  This | 
 | happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one | 
 | of the input files. | 
 |  | 
 | When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared, | 
 | non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required | 
 | shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included | 
 | explicitly.  In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option | 
 | specifies the first set of directories to search.  The | 
 | @option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names | 
 | either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by | 
 | appearing multiple times. | 
 |  | 
 | The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search | 
 | directories.  They will be replaced by the full path to the directory | 
 | containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN} | 
 | and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for | 
 | 64-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}. | 
 |  | 
 | The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and | 
 | @var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used.  The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not | 
 | supported. | 
 |  | 
 | This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path | 
 | that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it | 
 | is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the | 
 | runtime linker would do. | 
 |  | 
 | The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared | 
 | libraries: | 
 |  | 
 | @enumerate | 
 | @item | 
 | Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options. | 
 | @item | 
 | Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options.  The difference | 
 | between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories | 
 | specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and | 
 | used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective | 
 | at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported | 
 | by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with | 
 | the @option{--with-sysroot} option. | 
 | @item | 
 | On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and | 
 | @option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the | 
 | environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}. | 
 | @item | 
 | On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any | 
 | directories specified using @option{-L} options. | 
 | @item | 
 | For a native linker, search the contents of the environment | 
 | variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. | 
 | @item | 
 | For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or | 
 | @code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared | 
 | libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if | 
 | @code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist. | 
 | @item | 
 | For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf} | 
 | exists, the list of directories found in that file.  Note: the path | 
 | to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is | 
 | defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was | 
 | configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option. | 
 | @item | 
 | For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by | 
 | the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h} | 
 | header file. | 
 | @item | 
 | Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a | 
 | linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified | 
 | by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}). | 
 | @item | 
 | The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}. | 
 | @item | 
 | Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH. | 
 | @item | 
 | Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default | 
 | linker script. | 
 | @end enumerate | 
 |  | 
 | Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat:  If | 
 | the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library | 
 | is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this | 
 | library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so} | 
 | @emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search | 
 | directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and} | 
 | this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for | 
 | @file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead | 
 | of the first. | 
 |  | 
 | If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a | 
 | warning and continue with the link. | 
 |  | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -shared | 
 | @kindex -Bshareable | 
 | @item -shared | 
 | @itemx -Bshareable | 
 | @cindex shared libraries | 
 | Create a shared library.  This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF | 
 | and SunOS platforms.  On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a | 
 | shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are | 
 | undefined symbols in the link. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --sort-common | 
 | @item --sort-common | 
 | @itemx --sort-common=ascending | 
 | @itemx --sort-common=descending | 
 | This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in | 
 | ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output | 
 | sections.  The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger, | 
 | eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps | 
 | between symbols due to alignment constraints.  If no sorting order is | 
 | specified, then descending order is assumed. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --sort-section=name | 
 | @item --sort-section=name | 
 | This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section | 
 | patterns in the linker script. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --sort-section=alignment | 
 | @item --sort-section=alignment | 
 | This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section | 
 | patterns in the linker script. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --spare-dynamic-tags | 
 | @item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count} | 
 | This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the | 
 | .dynamic section of ELF shared objects.  Empty slots may be needed by | 
 | post processing tools, such as the prelinker.  The default is 5. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --split-by-file | 
 | @item --split-by-file[=@var{size}] | 
 | Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for | 
 | each input file when @var{size} is reached.  @var{size} defaults to a | 
 | size of 1 if not given. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --split-by-reloc | 
 | @item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}] | 
 | Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single | 
 | output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations. | 
 | This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into | 
 | certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF | 
 | cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section.  Note | 
 | that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not | 
 | support arbitrary sections.  The linker will not split up individual | 
 | input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains | 
 | more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that | 
 | many relocations.  @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --stats | 
 | @item --stats | 
 | Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such | 
 | as execution time and memory usage. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --sysroot=@var{directory} | 
 | @item --sysroot=@var{directory} | 
 | Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the | 
 | configure-time default.  This option is only supported by linkers | 
 | that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --task-link | 
 | @item --task-link | 
 | This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object | 
 | file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --traditional-format | 
 | @cindex traditional format | 
 | @item --traditional-format | 
 | For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from | 
 | the output of some existing linker.  This switch requests @command{ld} to | 
 | use the traditional format instead. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex dbx | 
 | For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the | 
 | symbol string table.  This can reduce the size of an output file with | 
 | full debugging information by over 30 percent.  Unfortunately, the SunOS | 
 | @code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no | 
 | trouble).  The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not | 
 | combine duplicate entries. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org} | 
 | @item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org} | 
 | Locate a section in the output file at the absolute | 
 | address given by @var{org}.  You may use this option as many | 
 | times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command | 
 | line. | 
 | @var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer; | 
 | for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading | 
 | @samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values.  @emph{Note:} there | 
 | should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals | 
 | sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Tbss=@var{org} | 
 | @kindex -Tdata=@var{org} | 
 | @kindex -Ttext=@var{org} | 
 | @cindex segment origins, cmd line | 
 | @item -Tbss=@var{org} | 
 | @itemx -Tdata=@var{org} | 
 | @itemx -Ttext=@var{org} | 
 | Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or | 
 | @code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org} | 
 | @item -Ttext-segment=@var{org} | 
 | @cindex text segment origin, cmd line | 
 | When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first | 
 | byte of the text segment. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org} | 
 | @item -Trodata-segment=@var{org} | 
 | @cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line | 
 | When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where | 
 | the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable | 
 | text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org} | 
 | @item -Tldata-segment=@var{org} | 
 | @cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line | 
 | When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory | 
 | model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --unresolved-symbols | 
 | @item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method} | 
 | Determine how to handle unresolved symbols.  There are four possible | 
 | values for @samp{method}: | 
 |  | 
 | @table @samp | 
 | @item ignore-all | 
 | Do not report any unresolved symbols. | 
 |  | 
 | @item report-all | 
 | Report all unresolved symbols.  This is the default. | 
 |  | 
 | @item ignore-in-object-files | 
 | Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but | 
 | ignore them if they come from regular object files. | 
 |  | 
 | @item ignore-in-shared-libs | 
 | Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but | 
 | ignore them if they come from shared libraries.  This can be useful | 
 | when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared | 
 | libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's | 
 | command line. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled | 
 | by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option. | 
 |  | 
 | Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported | 
 | unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols} | 
 | can change this to a warning. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}] | 
 | @cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}] | 
 | @item --dll-verbose | 
 | @itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}] | 
 | Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations | 
 | supported.  Display which input files can and cannot be opened.  Display | 
 | the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER} | 
 | argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile} | 
 | @cindex version script, symbol versions | 
 | @item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile} | 
 | Specify the name of a version script to the linker.  This is typically | 
 | used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information | 
 | about the version hierarchy for the library being created.  This option | 
 | is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries; | 
 | see @ref{VERSION}.  It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can | 
 | use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any | 
 | symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported. | 
 | @xref{WIN32}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --warn-common | 
 | @cindex warnings, on combining symbols | 
 | @cindex combining symbols, warnings on | 
 | @item --warn-common | 
 | Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with | 
 | a symbol definition.  Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice, | 
 | but linkers on some other operating systems do not.  This option allows | 
 | you to find potential problems from combining global symbols. | 
 | Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some | 
 | warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs. | 
 |  | 
 | There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples: | 
 |  | 
 | @table @samp | 
 | @item int i = 1; | 
 | A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output | 
 | file. | 
 |  | 
 | @item extern int i; | 
 | An undefined reference, which does not allocate space. | 
 | There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the | 
 | variable somewhere. | 
 |  | 
 | @item int i; | 
 | A common symbol.  If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a | 
 | variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file. | 
 | The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a | 
 | single symbol.  If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest | 
 | size.  The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is | 
 | a definition of the same variable. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings. | 
 | Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol | 
 | just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol | 
 | encountered with the same name.  One or both of the two symbols will be | 
 | a common symbol. | 
 |  | 
 | @enumerate | 
 | @item | 
 | Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a | 
 | definition for the symbol. | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}' | 
 |    overridden by definition | 
 | @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for | 
 | the symbol is encountered.  This is the same as the previous case, | 
 | except that the symbols are encountered in a different order. | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}' | 
 |    overriding common | 
 | @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol. | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common | 
 |    of `@var{symbol}' | 
 | @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol. | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}' | 
 |    overridden by larger common | 
 | @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol.  This is | 
 | the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are | 
 | encountered in a different order. | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}' | 
 |    overriding smaller common | 
 | @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @end enumerate | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --warn-constructors | 
 | @item --warn-constructors | 
 | Warn if any global constructors are used.  This is only useful for a few | 
 | object file formats.  For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not | 
 | detect the use of global constructors. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --warn-execstack | 
 | @cindex warnings, on executable stack | 
 | @cindex executable stack, warnings on | 
 | @item --warn-execstack | 
 | @itemx --no-warn-execstack | 
 | On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning | 
 | messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack.  By | 
 | default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command | 
 | line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the | 
 | @option{--warn-execstack} option. | 
 |  | 
 | On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made | 
 | executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable | 
 | stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z | 
 | noexecstack} command line options have been specified.  This warning | 
 | can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option. | 
 |  | 
 | Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable | 
 | stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable | 
 | bit set in its section flags.  They can specify that they do not need | 
 | an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable | 
 | flag bit set.  If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack} | 
 | section present then the default behaviour is target specific.  For | 
 | some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an | 
 | executable stack @emph{is} required.  This is often a problem for hand | 
 | crafted assembler files. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --warn-multiple-gp | 
 | @item --warn-multiple-gp | 
 | Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file. | 
 | This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha. | 
 | Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special | 
 | section.  A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle | 
 | of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a | 
 | base-register relative addressing mode.  Since the offset in | 
 | base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16 | 
 | bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool.  Thus, in | 
 | large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer | 
 | values in order to be able to address all possible constants.  This | 
 | option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --warn-once | 
 | @cindex warnings, on undefined symbols | 
 | @cindex undefined symbols, warnings on | 
 | @item --warn-once | 
 | Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module | 
 | which refers to it. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --warn-rwx-segments | 
 | @cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments | 
 | @cindex executable segments, warnings on | 
 | @item --warn-rwx-segments | 
 | @itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments | 
 | Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has | 
 | all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set.  Such a | 
 | segment represents a potential security vulnerability.  In addition | 
 | warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is | 
 | created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or | 
 | not it has the read and/or write flags set. | 
 |  | 
 | These warnings are enabled by default.  They can be disabled via the | 
 | @option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the | 
 | @option{--warn-rwx-segments} option. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --warn-section-align | 
 | @cindex warnings, on section alignment | 
 | @cindex section alignment, warnings on | 
 | @item --warn-section-align | 
 | Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of | 
 | alignment.  Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section. | 
 | The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that | 
 | is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for | 
 | the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}). | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --warn-textrel | 
 | @item --warn-textrel | 
 | Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable | 
 | or shared object. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --warn-alternate-em | 
 | @item --warn-alternate-em | 
 | Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols | 
 | @item --warn-unresolved-symbols | 
 | If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option | 
 | @option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error. | 
 | This option makes it generate a warning instead. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --error-unresolved-symbols | 
 | @item --error-unresolved-symbols | 
 | This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when | 
 | it is reporting unresolved symbols. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --whole-archive | 
 | @cindex including an entire archive | 
 | @item --whole-archive | 
 | For each archive mentioned on the command line after the | 
 | @option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive | 
 | in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object | 
 | files.  This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared | 
 | library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared | 
 | library.  This option may be used more than once. | 
 |  | 
 | Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know | 
 | about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}. | 
 | Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your | 
 | list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to | 
 | your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --wrap=@var{symbol} | 
 | @item --wrap=@var{symbol} | 
 | Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}.  Any undefined reference to | 
 | @var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}.  Any | 
 | undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to | 
 | @var{symbol}. | 
 |  | 
 | This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function.  The | 
 | wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}.  If it | 
 | wishes to call the system function, it should call | 
 | @code{__real_@var{symbol}}. | 
 |  | 
 | Here is a trivial example: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | void * | 
 | __wrap_malloc (size_t c) | 
 | @{ | 
 |   printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c); | 
 |   return __real_malloc (c); | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then | 
 | all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc} | 
 | instead.  The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will | 
 | call the real @code{malloc} function. | 
 |  | 
 | You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that | 
 | links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed.  If you do this, | 
 | you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same | 
 | file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the | 
 | call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}. | 
 |  | 
 | Only undefined references are replaced by the linker.  So, translation unit | 
 | internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to | 
 | @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}.  In the next example, the call to @code{f} in | 
 | @code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | int | 
 | f (void) | 
 | @{ | 
 |   return 123; | 
 | @} | 
 |  | 
 | int | 
 | g (void) | 
 | @{ | 
 |   return f(); | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --eh-frame-hdr | 
 | @kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr | 
 | @item --eh-frame-hdr | 
 | @itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr | 
 | Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress | 
 | (@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr} | 
 | section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info | 
 | @item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info | 
 | Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker | 
 | generated code sections like PLT.  This option is on by default | 
 | if linker generated unwind info is supported.  This option also | 
 | controls the generation of @code{.sframe} stack trace info for linker | 
 | generated code sections like PLT. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --enable-new-dtags | 
 | @kindex --disable-new-dtags | 
 | @item --enable-new-dtags | 
 | @itemx --disable-new-dtags | 
 | This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF | 
 | systems may not understand them. If you specify | 
 | @option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed | 
 | and older dynamic tags will be omitted. | 
 | If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be | 
 | created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that | 
 | those options are only available for ELF systems. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --hash-size=@var{number} | 
 | @item --hash-size=@var{number} | 
 | Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number | 
 | close to @var{number}.  Increasing this value can reduce the length of | 
 | time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of | 
 | increasing the linker's memory requirements.  Similarly reducing this | 
 | value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --hash-style=@var{style} | 
 | @item --hash-style=@var{style} | 
 | Set the type of linker's hash table(s).  @var{style} can be either | 
 | @code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for | 
 | new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both | 
 | the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} | 
 | hash tables.  The default depends upon how the linker was configured, | 
 | but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --compress-debug-sections=none | 
 | @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib | 
 | @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu | 
 | @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi | 
 | @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zstd | 
 | @item --compress-debug-sections=none | 
 | @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib | 
 | @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu | 
 | @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi | 
 | @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zstd | 
 | On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are | 
 | compressed using zlib. | 
 |  | 
 | @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug | 
 | sections.  @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses | 
 | DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug} | 
 | instead of @samp{.debug}.  @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi} | 
 | also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it | 
 | sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers. | 
 |  | 
 | The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for | 
 | @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}. | 
 |  | 
 | @option{--compress-debug-sections=zstd} compresses DWARF debug sections using | 
 | zstd. | 
 |  | 
 | Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug | 
 | sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} | 
 | for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be | 
 | uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary. | 
 |  | 
 | The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target | 
 | involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain.  The | 
 | default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's | 
 | @option{--help} option. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --reduce-memory-overheads | 
 | @item --reduce-memory-overheads | 
 | This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of | 
 | linking speed.  This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm | 
 | for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses | 
 | about 40% more memory for symbol storage. | 
 |  | 
 | Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to | 
 | 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's | 
 | run time.  This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch | 
 | has been used. | 
 |  | 
 | The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to | 
 | enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size} | 
 | @item --max-cache-size=@var{size} | 
 | @command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables | 
 | of input files in memory with the unlimited size.  This option sets the | 
 | maximum cache size to @var{size}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --build-id | 
 | @kindex --build-id=@var{style} | 
 | @item --build-id | 
 | @itemx --build-id=@var{style} | 
 | Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section | 
 | or a @code{.buildid} COFF section.  The contents of the note are | 
 | unique bits identifying this linked file.  @var{style} can be | 
 | @code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit | 
 | @sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents, | 
 | @code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of | 
 | the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit | 
 | string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and | 
 | @code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored).  If @var{style} | 
 | is omitted, @code{sha1} is used. | 
 |  | 
 | The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier | 
 | that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be | 
 | unique among all nonidentical output files.  It is not intended | 
 | to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents.  A linked | 
 | file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit | 
 | string identifying the original linked file does not change. | 
 |  | 
 | Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any | 
 | @code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON} | 
 | @item --package-metadata=@var{JSON} | 
 | Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section.  The | 
 | contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata | 
 | specification.  For more information see: | 
 | https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/ | 
 | If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the | 
 | creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier | 
 | occurrence of the --package-metdata option. | 
 | If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string | 
 | will be validated. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @c man end | 
 |  | 
 | @subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets | 
 |  | 
 | @c man begin OPTIONS | 
 |  | 
 | The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes | 
 | the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a | 
 | normal executable.  You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you | 
 | use this option.  In addition, the linker fully supports the standard | 
 | @code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line | 
 | like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports | 
 | symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal | 
 | object file). | 
 |  | 
 | In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker | 
 | support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386 | 
 | PE target.  Options that take values may be separated from their | 
 | values by either a space or an equals sign. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @gcctabopt | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --add-stdcall-alias | 
 | @item --add-stdcall-alias | 
 | If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported | 
 | as-is and also with the suffix stripped. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --base-file | 
 | @item --base-file @var{file} | 
 | Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base | 
 | addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with | 
 | @file{dlltool}. | 
 | [This is an i386 PE specific option] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --dll | 
 | @item --dll | 
 | Create a DLL instead of a regular executable.  You may also use | 
 | @option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def} | 
 | file. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --enable-long-section-names | 
 | @kindex --disable-long-section-names | 
 | @item --enable-long-section-names | 
 | @itemx --disable-long-section-names | 
 | The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits | 
 | the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit | 
 | for COFF.  By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as | 
 | fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required | 
 | to support the longer names.  As a GNU extension, it is possible to | 
 | allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!) | 
 | disallow it in object files, by using these two options.  Executable images | 
 | generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying | 
 | as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined | 
 | with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers.  However, | 
 | GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug | 
 | information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither | 
 | option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long | 
 | section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour, | 
 | when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable | 
 | image and not stripping symbols. | 
 | [This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup | 
 | @kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup | 
 | @item --enable-stdcall-fixup | 
 | @itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup | 
 | If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to | 
 | do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs | 
 | only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will | 
 | resolve that symbol by linking to the match.  For example, the | 
 | undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function | 
 | @code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked | 
 | to the function @code{_bar}.  When the linker does this, it prints a | 
 | warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes | 
 | import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature | 
 | to be usable.  If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this | 
 | feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed.  If you specify | 
 | @option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such | 
 | mismatches are considered to be errors. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --leading-underscore | 
 | @kindex --no-leading-underscore | 
 | @item --leading-underscore | 
 | @itemx --no-leading-underscore | 
 | For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined | 
 | in target's description. By this option it is possible to | 
 | disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex DLLs, creating | 
 | @kindex --export-all-symbols | 
 | @item --export-all-symbols | 
 | If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will | 
 | be exported by the DLL.  Note that this is the default if there | 
 | otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols.  When symbols are | 
 | explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function | 
 | attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this | 
 | option is given.  Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12}, | 
 | @code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and | 
 | @code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically | 
 | exported.  Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be | 
 | re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout | 
 | such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with | 
 | @code{_iname}.  In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc}, | 
 | @code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported. | 
 | Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will | 
 | not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs.  Finally, there is an | 
 | extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported | 
 | (obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets). | 
 | These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12}, | 
 | @code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12}, | 
 | @code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll}, | 
 | @code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2}, | 
 | @code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --exclude-symbols | 
 | @item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},... | 
 | Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically | 
 | exported.  The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --exclude-all-symbols | 
 | @item --exclude-all-symbols | 
 | Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --file-alignment | 
 | @item --file-alignment | 
 | Specify the file alignment.  Sections in the file will always begin at | 
 | file offsets which are multiples of this number.  This defaults to | 
 | 512. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex heap size | 
 | @kindex --heap | 
 | @item --heap @var{reserve} | 
 | @itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit} | 
 | Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit) | 
 | to be used as heap for this program.  The default is 1MB reserved, 4K | 
 | committed. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex image base | 
 | @kindex --image-base | 
 | @item --image-base @var{value} | 
 | Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll.  This is | 
 | the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll | 
 | is loaded.  To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of | 
 | your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any | 
 | other dlls.  The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000 | 
 | for dlls. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --kill-at | 
 | @item --kill-at | 
 | If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from | 
 | symbols before they are exported. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --large-address-aware | 
 | @item --large-address-aware | 
 | If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF | 
 | header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses | 
 | greater than 2 gigabytes.  This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB | 
 | or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]'' | 
 | section of the BOOT.INI.  Otherwise, this bit has no effect. | 
 | [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --disable-large-address-aware | 
 | @item --disable-large-address-aware | 
 | Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option. | 
 | This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler | 
 | driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual | 
 | addresses greater than 2 gigabytes. | 
 | [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --major-image-version | 
 | @item --major-image-version @var{value} | 
 | Sets the major number of the ``image version''.  Defaults to 1. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --major-os-version | 
 | @item --major-os-version @var{value} | 
 | Sets the major number of the ``os version''.  Defaults to 4. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --major-subsystem-version | 
 | @item --major-subsystem-version @var{value} | 
 | Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''.  Defaults to 4. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --minor-image-version | 
 | @item --minor-image-version @var{value} | 
 | Sets the minor number of the ``image version''.  Defaults to 0. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --minor-os-version | 
 | @item --minor-os-version @var{value} | 
 | Sets the minor number of the ``os version''.  Defaults to 0. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --minor-subsystem-version | 
 | @item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value} | 
 | Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''.  Defaults to 0. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex DEF files, creating | 
 | @cindex DLLs, creating | 
 | @kindex --output-def | 
 | @item --output-def @var{file} | 
 | The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF | 
 | file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating.  This DEF file | 
 | (which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import | 
 | library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to | 
 | automatically or implicitly exported symbols. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex DLLs, creating | 
 | @kindex --enable-auto-image-base | 
 | @item --enable-auto-image-base | 
 | @itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value} | 
 | Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base | 
 | @var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument. | 
 | By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases | 
 | for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program | 
 | execution are avoided. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --disable-auto-image-base | 
 | @item --disable-auto-image-base | 
 | Do not automatically generate a unique image base.  If there is no | 
 | user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform | 
 | default. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex DLLs, linking to | 
 | @kindex --dll-search-prefix | 
 | @item --dll-search-prefix @var{string} | 
 | When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library, | 
 | search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to | 
 | @code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction | 
 | between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin, | 
 | uwin, pw, etc.  For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use | 
 | @code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --enable-auto-import | 
 | @item --enable-auto-import | 
 | Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for | 
 | DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport | 
 | mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the | 
 | feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets. | 
 |  | 
 | Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section | 
 | of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the | 
 | PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft. | 
 |  | 
 | Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only | 
 | data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be | 
 | placed into the .data section instead.  This is in order to work | 
 | around a problem with consts that is described here: | 
 | http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html | 
 |  | 
 | Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may | 
 | see this message: | 
 |  | 
 | "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the | 
 | documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details." | 
 |  | 
 | This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address | 
 | ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only | 
 | allow one).  Instances where this may occur include accesses to member | 
 | fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a | 
 | constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL.  Any | 
 | multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger | 
 | this error condition.  However, regardless of the exact data type | 
 | of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue | 
 | the warning, and exit. | 
 |  | 
 | There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the | 
 | data type of the exported variable: | 
 |  | 
 | One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task | 
 | of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so | 
 | this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature. | 
 |  | 
 | A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable -- | 
 | that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time.  For arrays, | 
 | there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address) | 
 | a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable.  Thus: | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | extern type extern_array[]; | 
 | extern_array[1] --> | 
 |    @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @} | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | or | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | extern type extern_array[]; | 
 | extern_array[1] --> | 
 |    @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @} | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option | 
 | is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable: | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | extern struct s extern_struct; | 
 | extern_struct.field --> | 
 |    @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @} | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | or | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | extern long long extern_ll; | 
 | extern_ll --> | 
 |   @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @} | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon | 
 | 'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with | 
 | @code{__declspec(dllimport)}.  However, in practice that | 
 | requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are | 
 | building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or | 
 | merely building/linking to a static library.   In making the choice | 
 | between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with | 
 | constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage: | 
 |  | 
 | Original: | 
 | @example | 
 | --foo.h | 
 | extern int arr[]; | 
 | --foo.c | 
 | #include "foo.h" | 
 | void main(int argc, char **argv)@{ | 
 |   printf("%d\n",arr[1]); | 
 | @} | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | Solution 1: | 
 | @example | 
 | --foo.h | 
 | extern int arr[]; | 
 | --foo.c | 
 | #include "foo.h" | 
 | void main(int argc, char **argv)@{ | 
 |   /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */ | 
 |   volatile int *parr = arr; | 
 |   printf("%d\n",parr[1]); | 
 | @} | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | Solution 2: | 
 | @example | 
 | --foo.h | 
 | /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */ | 
 | #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \ | 
 |   !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC)) | 
 | #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport) | 
 | #else | 
 | #define FOO_IMPORT | 
 | #endif | 
 | extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[]; | 
 | --foo.c | 
 | #include "foo.h" | 
 | void main(int argc, char **argv)@{ | 
 |   printf("%d\n",arr[1]); | 
 | @} | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your | 
 | library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface | 
 | for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor | 
 | functions). | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --disable-auto-import | 
 | @item --disable-auto-import | 
 | Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to | 
 | @code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc | 
 | @item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc | 
 | If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section, | 
 | that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create | 
 | a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime | 
 | environment to adjust references to such data in your client code. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc | 
 | @item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc | 
 | Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug | 
 | @item --enable-extra-pe-debug | 
 | Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --section-alignment | 
 | @item --section-alignment | 
 | Sets the section alignment.  Sections in memory will always begin at | 
 | addresses which are a multiple of this number.  Defaults to 0x1000. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex stack size | 
 | @kindex --stack | 
 | @item --stack @var{reserve} | 
 | @itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit} | 
 | Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit) | 
 | to be used as stack for this program.  The default is 2MB reserved, 4K | 
 | committed. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --subsystem | 
 | @item --subsystem @var{which} | 
 | @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major} | 
 | @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor} | 
 | Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute.  The | 
 | legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows}, | 
 | @code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}.  You may optionally set | 
 | the subsystem version also.  Numeric values are also accepted for | 
 | @var{which}. | 
 | [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field | 
 | of the PE file header: | 
 | [These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker] | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --high-entropy-va | 
 | @item --high-entropy-va | 
 | @itemx --disable-high-entropy-va | 
 | Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization | 
 | (ASLR).  This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images. | 
 |  | 
 | This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and | 
 | @option{--enable-reloc-section}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --dynamicbase | 
 | @item --dynamicbase | 
 | @itemx --disable-dynamicbase | 
 | The image base address may be relocated using address space layout | 
 | randomization (ASLR).  This feature was introduced with MS Windows | 
 | Vista for i386 PE targets.  This option is enabled by default but | 
 | can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option. | 
 | This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --forceinteg | 
 | @item --forceinteg | 
 | @itemx --disable-forceinteg | 
 | Code integrity checks are enforced.  This option is disabled by | 
 | default. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --nxcompat | 
 | @item --nxcompat | 
 | @item --disable-nxcompat | 
 | The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention. | 
 | This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE | 
 | targets.  The option is enabled by default. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-isolation | 
 | @item --no-isolation | 
 | @itemx --disable-no-isolation | 
 | Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image. | 
 | This option is disabled by default. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-seh | 
 | @item --no-seh | 
 | @itemx --disable-no-seh | 
 | The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from | 
 | this image.  This option is disabled by default. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-bind | 
 | @item --no-bind | 
 | @itemx --disable-no-bind | 
 | Do not bind this image.  This option is disabled by default. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --wdmdriver | 
 | @item --wdmdriver | 
 | @itemx --disable-wdmdriver | 
 | The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model.  This option is disabled | 
 | by default. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --tsaware | 
 | @item --tsaware | 
 | @itemx --disable-tsaware | 
 | The image is Terminal Server aware.  This option is disabled by | 
 | default. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --insert-timestamp | 
 | @item --insert-timestamp | 
 | @itemx --no-insert-timestamp | 
 | Insert a real timestamp into the image.  This is the default behaviour | 
 | as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with | 
 | other, proprietary tools.  The problem with this default is that it | 
 | will result in slightly different images being produced each time the | 
 | same sources are linked.  The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp} | 
 | can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring | 
 | that binaries produced from identical sources will compare | 
 | identically. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --enable-reloc-section | 
 | @item --enable-reloc-section | 
 | @itemx --disable-reloc-section | 
 | Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image | 
 | is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header. | 
 | This option is enabled by default. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @c man end | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset C6X | 
 | @subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets | 
 |  | 
 | @c man begin OPTIONS | 
 |  | 
 | The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared | 
 | libraries.  Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index; | 
 | all executables use an index of 0. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @gcctabopt | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --dsbt-size | 
 | @item --dsbt-size @var{size} | 
 | This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable | 
 | or shared library to @var{size}.  The default is to create a table with 64 | 
 | entries. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --dsbt-index | 
 | @item --dsbt-index @var{index} | 
 | This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library | 
 | to @var{index}.  The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating | 
 | executables.  If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the | 
 | @code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries | 
 | The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent | 
 | exidx entries in frame unwind info. | 
 |  | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @c man end | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset CSKY | 
 | @subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets | 
 |  | 
 | @c man begin OPTIONS | 
 |  | 
 | @table @gcctabopt | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY | 
 | @item --branch-stub | 
 | This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub | 
 | sections when needed to extend the range of branches.  This option is | 
 | usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that | 
 | can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by | 
 | the compiler or assembler. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY | 
 | @item --stub-group-size=@var{N} | 
 | This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation. | 
 | It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can | 
 | be handled by one stub section.  A negative value of @var{N} locates | 
 | stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub | 
 | sections to appear either before or after the branches.  Values of | 
 | @samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the | 
 | linker should choose suitable defaults. | 
 |  | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @c man end | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset M68HC11 | 
 | @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets | 
 |  | 
 | @c man begin OPTIONS | 
 |  | 
 | The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the | 
 | memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @gcctabopt | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-trampoline | 
 | @item --no-trampoline | 
 | This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline | 
 | is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr} | 
 | instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken). | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --bank-window | 
 | @item --bank-window @var{name} | 
 | This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in | 
 | the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window. | 
 | The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute | 
 | paging and addresses within the memory window. | 
 |  | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @c man end | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset M68K | 
 | @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target | 
 |  | 
 | @c man begin OPTIONS | 
 |  | 
 | The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation | 
 | when linking for 68K targets. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @gcctabopt | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --got | 
 | @item --got=@var{type} | 
 | This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use. | 
 | @var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, | 
 | @samp{multigot} or @samp{target}.  For more information refer to the | 
 | Info entry for @file{ld}. | 
 |  | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @c man end | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset MIPS | 
 | @subsection Options specific to MIPS targets | 
 |  | 
 | @c man begin OPTIONS | 
 |  | 
 | The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction | 
 | generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when | 
 | linking for MIPS targets. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @gcctabopt | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --insn32 | 
 | @item --insn32 | 
 | @kindex --no-insn32 | 
 | @itemx --no-insn32 | 
 | These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code | 
 | generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, | 
 | or in relaxation.  If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses | 
 | 32-bit instruction encodings.  By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is | 
 | used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where | 
 | possible. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --ignore-branch-isa | 
 | @item --ignore-branch-isa | 
 | @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa | 
 | @itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa | 
 | These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode | 
 | transitions.  If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker | 
 | accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required | 
 | is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} | 
 | instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to | 
 | equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is | 
 | calculated.  By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used | 
 | a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce | 
 | an error. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --compact-branches | 
 | @item --compact-branches | 
 | @kindex --no-compact-branches | 
 | @itemx --no-compact-branches | 
 | These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker | 
 | in the PLT entries for MIPS R6. | 
 |  | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @c man end | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset PDP11 | 
 | @subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets | 
 |  | 
 | @c man begin OPTIONS | 
 |  | 
 | For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be | 
 | produced as selected by the following options.  The default variant | 
 | for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other | 
 | targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default.  The @samp{--imagic} option is | 
 | defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described | 
 | here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @gcctabopt | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -N | 
 | @item -N | 
 | @kindex --omagic | 
 | @itemx --omagic | 
 |  | 
 | Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to | 
 | indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and | 
 | shared.  Since the text and data sections are both readable and | 
 | writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after | 
 | the text segment.  This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable | 
 | programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems | 
 | from the beginning through 2.11BSD. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -n | 
 | @item -n | 
 | @kindex --nmagic | 
 | @itemx --nmagic | 
 |  | 
 | Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to | 
 | indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will | 
 | be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same | 
 | file.  This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K | 
 | byte page boundary following the end of the text.  This option creates | 
 | a @emph{pure executable} format. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex -z | 
 | @item -z | 
 | @kindex --imagic | 
 | @itemx --imagic | 
 |  | 
 | Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to | 
 | indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and | 
 | data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split | 
 | instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in | 
 | larger models of the PDP11.  This doubles the address space available | 
 | to the program.  The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and | 
 | shareable.  The only difference in the output format between this | 
 | option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text | 
 | and data sections start at location 0.  The @samp{-z} option selected | 
 | this format in 2.11BSD.  This option creates a @emph{separate | 
 | executable} format. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-omagic | 
 | @item --no-omagic | 
 |  | 
 | Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout. | 
 |  | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @c man end | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset UsesEnvVars | 
 | @node Environment | 
 | @section Environment Variables | 
 |  | 
 | @c man begin ENVIRONMENT | 
 |  | 
 | You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables | 
 | @ifclear SingleFormat | 
 | @code{GNUTARGET}, | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear SingleFormat | 
 | @kindex GNUTARGET | 
 | @cindex default input format | 
 | @code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't | 
 | use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}).  Its value should be one | 
 | of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}).  If there is no | 
 | @code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format | 
 | of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD | 
 | attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files; | 
 | this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since | 
 | there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify | 
 | object-file formats is unique.  However, the configuration procedure for | 
 | BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first | 
 | in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention. | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex LDEMULATION | 
 | @cindex default emulation | 
 | @cindex emulation, default | 
 | @code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the | 
 | @samp{-m} option.  The emulation can affect various aspects of linker | 
 | behaviour, particularly the default linker script.  You can list the | 
 | available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.  If | 
 | the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment | 
 | variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the | 
 | linker was configured. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE | 
 | @cindex demangling, default | 
 | Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols.  However, if | 
 | @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will | 
 | default to not demangling symbols.  This environment variable is used in | 
 | a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program.  The default | 
 | may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle} | 
 | options. | 
 |  | 
 | @c man end | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @node Scripts | 
 | @chapter Linker Scripts | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex scripts | 
 | @cindex linker scripts | 
 | @cindex command files | 
 | Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}.  This script is | 
 | written in the linker command language. | 
 |  | 
 | The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in | 
 | the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control | 
 | the memory layout of the output file.  Most linker scripts do nothing | 
 | more than this.  However, when necessary, the linker script can also | 
 | direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands | 
 | described below. | 
 |  | 
 | The linker always uses a linker script.  If you do not supply one | 
 | yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the | 
 | linker executable.  You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option | 
 | to display the default linker script.  Certain command-line options, | 
 | such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script. | 
 |  | 
 | You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command | 
 | line option.  When you do this, your linker script will replace the | 
 | default linker script. | 
 |  | 
 | You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files | 
 | to the linker, as though they were files to be linked.  @xref{Implicit | 
 | Linker Scripts}. | 
 |  | 
 | @menu | 
 | * Basic Script Concepts::	Basic Linker Script Concepts | 
 | * Script Format::		Linker Script Format | 
 | * Simple Example::		Simple Linker Script Example | 
 | * Simple Commands::		Simple Linker Script Commands | 
 | * Assignments::			Assigning Values to Symbols | 
 | * SECTIONS::			SECTIONS Command | 
 | * MEMORY::			MEMORY Command | 
 | * PHDRS::			PHDRS Command | 
 | * VERSION::			VERSION Command | 
 | * Expressions::			Expressions in Linker Scripts | 
 | * Implicit Linker Scripts::	Implicit Linker Scripts | 
 | @end menu | 
 |  | 
 | @node Basic Script Concepts | 
 | @section Basic Linker Script Concepts | 
 | @cindex linker script concepts | 
 | We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to | 
 | describe the linker script language. | 
 |  | 
 | The linker combines input files into a single output file.  The output | 
 | file and each input file are in a special data format known as an | 
 | @dfn{object file format}.  Each file is called an @dfn{object file}. | 
 | The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our | 
 | purposes we will also call it an object file.  Each object file has, | 
 | among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}.  We sometimes refer to a | 
 | section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section | 
 | in the output file is an @dfn{output section}. | 
 |  | 
 | Each section in an object file has a name and a size.  Most sections | 
 | also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section | 
 | contents}.  A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that | 
 | the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run. | 
 | A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an | 
 | area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be | 
 | loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out).  A section | 
 | which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort | 
 | of debugging information. | 
 |  | 
 | Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses.  The | 
 | first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address.  This is the address | 
 | the section will have when the output file is run.  The second is the | 
 | @dfn{LMA}, or load memory address.  This is the address at which the | 
 | section will be loaded.  In most cases the two addresses will be the | 
 | same.  An example of when they might be different is when a data section | 
 | is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up | 
 | (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM | 
 | based system).  In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the | 
 | RAM address would be the VMA. | 
 |  | 
 | You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump} | 
 | program with the @samp{-h} option. | 
 |  | 
 | Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the | 
 | @dfn{symbol table}.  A symbol may be defined or undefined.  Each symbol | 
 | has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other | 
 | information.  If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you | 
 | will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or | 
 | static variable.  Every undefined function or global variable which is | 
 | referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol. | 
 |  | 
 | You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm} | 
 | program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t} | 
 | option. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Script Format | 
 | @section Linker Script Format | 
 | @cindex linker script format | 
 | Linker scripts are text files. | 
 |  | 
 | You write a linker script as a series of commands.  Each command is | 
 | either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a | 
 | symbol.  You may separate commands using semicolons.  Whitespace is | 
 | generally ignored. | 
 |  | 
 | Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly. | 
 | If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would | 
 | otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in | 
 | double quotes.  There is no way to use a double quote character in a | 
 | file name. | 
 |  | 
 | You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by | 
 | @samp{/*} and @samp{*/}.  As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent | 
 | to whitespace. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Simple Example | 
 | @section Simple Linker Script Example | 
 | @cindex linker script example | 
 | @cindex example of linker script | 
 | Many linker scripts are fairly simple. | 
 |  | 
 | The simplest possible linker script has just one command: | 
 | @samp{SECTIONS}.  You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the | 
 | memory layout of the output file. | 
 |  | 
 | The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command.  Here we will | 
 | describe a simple use of it.  Let's assume your program consists only of | 
 | code, initialized data, and uninitialized data.  These will be in the | 
 | @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively. | 
 | Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in | 
 | your input files. | 
 |  | 
 | For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address | 
 | 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000.  Here is a | 
 | linker script which will do that: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |   . = 0x10000; | 
 |   .text : @{ *(.text) @} | 
 |   . = 0x8000000; | 
 |   .data : @{ *(.data) @} | 
 |   .bss : @{ *(.bss) @} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS}, | 
 | followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section | 
 | descriptions enclosed in curly braces. | 
 |  | 
 | The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example | 
 | sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location | 
 | counter.  If you do not specify the address of an output section in some | 
 | other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the | 
 | current value of the location counter.  The location counter is then | 
 | incremented by the size of the output section.  At the start of the | 
 | @samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}. | 
 |  | 
 | The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}.  The colon is | 
 | required syntax which may be ignored for now.  Within the curly braces | 
 | after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections | 
 | which should be placed into this output section.  The @samp{*} is a | 
 | wildcard which matches any file name.  The expression @samp{*(.text)} | 
 | means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files. | 
 |  | 
 | Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section | 
 | @samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the | 
 | @samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}. | 
 |  | 
 | The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in | 
 | the output file.  The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section | 
 | at address @samp{0x8000000}.  After the linker places the @samp{.data} | 
 | output section, the value of the location counter will be | 
 | @samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section.  The | 
 | effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section | 
 | immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory. | 
 |  | 
 | The linker will ensure that each output section has the required | 
 | alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary.  In this | 
 | example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data} | 
 | sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker | 
 | may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} | 
 | sections. | 
 |  | 
 | That's it!  That's a simple and complete linker script. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Simple Commands | 
 | @section Simple Linker Script Commands | 
 | @cindex linker script simple commands | 
 | In this section we describe the simple linker script commands. | 
 |  | 
 | @menu | 
 | * Entry Point::			Setting the entry point | 
 | * File Commands::		Commands dealing with files | 
 | @ifclear SingleFormat | 
 | * Format Commands::		Commands dealing with object file formats | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | * REGION_ALIAS::		Assign alias names to memory regions | 
 | * Miscellaneous Commands::	Other linker script commands | 
 | @end menu | 
 |  | 
 | @node Entry Point | 
 | @subsection Setting the Entry Point | 
 | @kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol}) | 
 | @cindex start of execution | 
 | @cindex first instruction | 
 | @cindex entry point | 
 | The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry | 
 | point}.  You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the | 
 | entry point.  The argument is a symbol name: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | ENTRY(@var{symbol}) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | There are several ways to set the entry point.  The linker will set the | 
 | entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and | 
 | stopping when one of them succeeds: | 
 | @itemize @bullet | 
 | @item | 
 | the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option; | 
 | @item | 
 | the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script; | 
 | @item | 
 | the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined;  For many | 
 | targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example | 
 | check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found. | 
 | @item | 
 | the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an | 
 | executable is being created - the code section is usually | 
 | @samp{.text}, but can be something else; | 
 | @item | 
 | The address @code{0}. | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | @node File Commands | 
 | @subsection Commands Dealing with Files | 
 | @cindex linker script file commands | 
 | Several linker script commands deal with files. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @code | 
 | @item INCLUDE @var{filename} | 
 | @kindex INCLUDE @var{filename} | 
 | @cindex including a linker script | 
 | Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point.  The file will | 
 | be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified | 
 | with the @option{-L} option.  You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to | 
 | 10 levels deep. | 
 |  | 
 | You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or | 
 | @code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions. | 
 |  | 
 | @item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{}) | 
 | @itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{}) | 
 | @kindex INPUT(@var{files}) | 
 | @cindex input files in linker scripts | 
 | @cindex input object files in linker scripts | 
 | @cindex linker script input object files | 
 | The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files | 
 | in the link, as though they were named on the command line. | 
 |  | 
 | For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do | 
 | a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line, | 
 | then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script. | 
 |  | 
 | In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker | 
 | script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option. | 
 |  | 
 | In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts | 
 | with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was | 
 | located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked | 
 | for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}.  The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying | 
 | @code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the | 
 | filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of | 
 | @samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}. | 
 |  | 
 | If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open | 
 | the file in the directory containing the linker script.  If it is not | 
 | found the linker will then search the current directory.  If it is still | 
 | not found the linker will search through the archive library search | 
 | path. | 
 |  | 
 | If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the | 
 | name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument | 
 | @samp{-l}. | 
 |  | 
 | When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the | 
 | files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker | 
 | script file is included.  This can affect archive searching. | 
 |  | 
 | @item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{}) | 
 | @itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{}) | 
 | @kindex GROUP(@var{files}) | 
 | @cindex grouping input files | 
 | The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named | 
 | files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no | 
 | new undefined references are created.  See the description of @samp{-(} | 
 | in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{}) | 
 | @itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{}) | 
 | @kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files}) | 
 | This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} | 
 | commands, among other filenames.  The files listed will be handled | 
 | as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands, | 
 | with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only | 
 | when they are actually needed.  This construct essentially enables | 
 | @option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it | 
 | and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed} | 
 | setting afterwards. | 
 |  | 
 | @item OUTPUT(@var{filename}) | 
 | @kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename}) | 
 | @cindex output file name in linker script | 
 | The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file.  Using | 
 | @code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using | 
 | @samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command | 
 | Line Options}).  If both are used, the command-line option takes | 
 | precedence. | 
 |  | 
 | You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the | 
 | output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path}) | 
 | @kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path}) | 
 | @cindex library search path in linker script | 
 | @cindex archive search path in linker script | 
 | @cindex search path in linker script | 
 | The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where | 
 | @command{ld} looks for archive libraries.  Using | 
 | @code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}} | 
 | on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}).  If both | 
 | are used, then the linker will search both paths.  Paths specified using | 
 | the command-line option are searched first. | 
 |  | 
 | @item STARTUP(@var{filename}) | 
 | @kindex STARTUP(@var{filename}) | 
 | @cindex first input file | 
 | The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except | 
 | that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as | 
 | though it were specified first on the command line.  This may be useful | 
 | when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the | 
 | first file. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear SingleFormat | 
 | @node Format Commands | 
 | @subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats | 
 | A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @code | 
 | @item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname}) | 
 | @itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little}) | 
 | @kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname}) | 
 | @cindex output file format in linker script | 
 | The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the | 
 | output file (@pxref{BFD}).  Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is | 
 | exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line | 
 | (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}).  If both are used, the command | 
 | line option takes precedence. | 
 |  | 
 | You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different | 
 | formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options. | 
 | This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the | 
 | desired endianness. | 
 |  | 
 | If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format | 
 | will be the first argument, @var{default}.  If @samp{-EB} is used, the | 
 | output format will be the second argument, @var{big}.  If @samp{-EL} is | 
 | used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}. | 
 |  | 
 | For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this | 
 | command: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | This says that the default format for the output file is | 
 | @samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line | 
 | option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips} | 
 | format. | 
 |  | 
 | @item TARGET(@var{bfdname}) | 
 | @kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname}) | 
 | @cindex input file format in linker script | 
 | The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input | 
 | files.  It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands. | 
 | This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line | 
 | (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}).  If the @code{TARGET} command | 
 | is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET} | 
 | command is also used to set the format for the output file.  @xref{BFD}. | 
 | @end table | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node REGION_ALIAS | 
 | @subsection Assign alias names to memory regions | 
 | @kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region}) | 
 | @cindex region alias | 
 | @cindex region names | 
 |  | 
 | Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the | 
 | @ref{MEMORY} command.  Each name corresponds to at most one memory region. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region}) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the | 
 | memory region @var{region}.  This allows a flexible mapping of output sections | 
 | to memory regions.  An example follows. | 
 |  | 
 | Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various | 
 | memory storage devices.  All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM} | 
 | that allows code execution or data storage.  Some may have a read-only, | 
 | non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data | 
 | access.  The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with | 
 | read-only data access and no code execution capability.  We have four output | 
 | sections: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize @bullet | 
 | @item | 
 | @code{.text} program code; | 
 | @item | 
 | @code{.rodata} read-only data; | 
 | @item | 
 | @code{.data} read-write initialized data; | 
 | @item | 
 | @code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data. | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent | 
 | part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the | 
 | output sections to the memory regions available on the system.  Our embedded | 
 | systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and | 
 | @code{C}: | 
 | @multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25 | 
 | @item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C | 
 | @item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM | 
 | @item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2 | 
 | @item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2 | 
 | @item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM | 
 | @end multitable | 
 | The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is | 
 | loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively.  Please note that | 
 | the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at | 
 | the end of the @code{.rodata} section. | 
 |  | 
 | The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows.  It | 
 | includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the | 
 | memory layout: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | INCLUDE linkcmds.memory | 
 |  | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     .text : | 
 |       @{ | 
 |         *(.text) | 
 |       @} > REGION_TEXT | 
 |     .rodata : | 
 |       @{ | 
 |         *(.rodata) | 
 |         rodata_end = .; | 
 |       @} > REGION_RODATA | 
 |     .data : AT (rodata_end) | 
 |       @{ | 
 |         data_start = .; | 
 |         *(.data) | 
 |       @} > REGION_DATA | 
 |     data_size = SIZEOF(.data); | 
 |     data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data); | 
 |     .bss : | 
 |       @{ | 
 |         *(.bss) | 
 |       @} > REGION_BSS | 
 |   @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory | 
 | regions and alias names.  The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three | 
 | variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}: | 
 | @table @code | 
 | @item A | 
 | Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}. | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | MEMORY | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M | 
 |   @} | 
 |  | 
 | REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM); | 
 | REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM); | 
 | REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM); | 
 | REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM); | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @item B | 
 | Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}.  Read-write data goes | 
 | into the @code{RAM}.  An image of the initialized data is loaded into the | 
 | @code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}. | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | MEMORY | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M | 
 |     RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M | 
 |   @} | 
 |  | 
 | REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM); | 
 | REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM); | 
 | REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM); | 
 | REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM); | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @item C | 
 | Program code goes into the @code{ROM}.  Read-only data goes into the | 
 | @code{ROM2}.  Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}.  An image of the | 
 | initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during | 
 | system start into the @code{RAM}. | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | MEMORY | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M | 
 |     ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M | 
 |     RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M | 
 |   @} | 
 |  | 
 | REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM); | 
 | REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2); | 
 | REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM); | 
 | REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM); | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the | 
 | @code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if | 
 | necessary: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | #include <string.h> | 
 |  | 
 | extern char data_start []; | 
 | extern char data_size []; | 
 | extern char data_load_start []; | 
 |  | 
 | void copy_data(void) | 
 | @{ | 
 |   if (data_start != data_load_start) | 
 |     @{ | 
 |       memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size); | 
 |     @} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @node Miscellaneous Commands | 
 | @subsection Other Linker Script Commands | 
 | There are a few other linker scripts commands. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @code | 
 | @item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message}) | 
 | @kindex ASSERT | 
 | @cindex assertion in linker script | 
 | Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero.  If it is zero, then exit the linker | 
 | with an error code, and print @var{message}. | 
 |  | 
 | Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking | 
 | take place.  This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd | 
 | inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values | 
 | for those symbols.  The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd | 
 | symbols that just reference dot.  Thus an assertion like this: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   .stack : | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     PROVIDE (__stack = .); | 
 |     PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100); | 
 |     ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack"); | 
 |   @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere.  Symbols | 
 | PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they | 
 | can be used inside ASSERTions.  Thus: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100); | 
 |   .stack : | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     PROVIDE (__stack = .); | 
 |     ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack"); | 
 |   @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | will work. | 
 |  | 
 | @item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{}) | 
 | @kindex EXTERN | 
 | @cindex undefined symbol in linker script | 
 | Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined | 
 | symbol.  Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional | 
 | modules from standard libraries.  You may list several @var{symbol}s for | 
 | each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times.  This | 
 | command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option. | 
 |  | 
 | @item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION | 
 | @kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION | 
 | @cindex common allocation in linker script | 
 | This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option: | 
 | to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable | 
 | output file is specified (@samp{-r}). | 
 |  | 
 | @item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION | 
 | @kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION | 
 | @cindex common allocation in linker script | 
 | This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common} | 
 | command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses | 
 | to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file. | 
 |  | 
 | @item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION | 
 | @kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION | 
 | @cindex group allocation in linker script | 
 | @cindex section groups | 
 | @cindex COMDAT | 
 | This command has the same effect as the | 
 | @samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make | 
 | @command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections, | 
 | and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is | 
 | specified (@samp{-r}). | 
 |  | 
 | @item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section} | 
 | @kindex INSERT | 
 | @cindex insert user script into default script | 
 | This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to | 
 | augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays.  It | 
 | inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before) | 
 | @var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the | 
 | default linker script.  The exact insertion point is as for orphan | 
 | sections.  @xref{Location Counter}.  The insertion happens after the | 
 | linker has mapped input sections to output sections.  Prior to the | 
 | insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default | 
 | linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the | 
 | default linker script statements in the internal linker representation | 
 | of the script.  In particular, input section assignments will be made | 
 | to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script.  Here | 
 | is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |   OVERLAY : | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @} | 
 |     .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @} | 
 |   @} | 
 | @} | 
 | INSERT AFTER .text; | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Note that when @samp{-T} is used twice, once to override the default | 
 | script and once to augment that script using @code{INSERT} the order | 
 | of parsing and section assignments apply as for the default script. | 
 | The script with @code{INSERT} should be specified @emph{first} on the | 
 | command line. | 
 |  | 
 | @item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{}) | 
 | @kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections}) | 
 | @cindex cross references | 
 | This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any | 
 | references among certain output sections. | 
 |  | 
 | In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when | 
 | using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section | 
 | will not be.  Any direct references between the two sections would be | 
 | errors.  For example, it would be an error if code in one section called | 
 | a function defined in the other section. | 
 |  | 
 | The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names.  If | 
 | @command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports | 
 | an error and returns a non-zero exit status.  Note that the | 
 | @code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section | 
 | names. | 
 |  | 
 | @item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{}) | 
 | @kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections}) | 
 | @cindex cross references | 
 | This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any | 
 | references to one section from a list of other sections. | 
 |  | 
 | The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more | 
 | output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where | 
 | a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application | 
 | there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety | 
 | must never call back. | 
 |  | 
 | The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names. | 
 | The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections. | 
 | If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of | 
 | the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit | 
 | status.  Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section | 
 | names, not input section names. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear SingleFormat | 
 | @item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch}) | 
 | @kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch}) | 
 | @cindex machine architecture | 
 | @cindex architecture | 
 | Specify a particular output machine architecture.  The argument is one | 
 | of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}).  You can see the | 
 | architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with | 
 | the @samp{-f} option. | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @item LD_FEATURE(@var{string}) | 
 | @kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string}) | 
 | This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior.  If | 
 | @var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers | 
 | in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere. | 
 | @xref{Expression Section}. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @node Assignments | 
 | @section Assigning Values to Symbols | 
 | @cindex assignment in scripts | 
 | @cindex symbol definition, scripts | 
 | @cindex variables, defining | 
 | You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script.  This will define | 
 | the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope. | 
 |  | 
 | @menu | 
 | * Simple Assignments::		Simple Assignments | 
 | * HIDDEN::			HIDDEN | 
 | * PROVIDE::			PROVIDE | 
 | * PROVIDE_HIDDEN::		PROVIDE_HIDDEN | 
 | * Source Code Reference::	How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code | 
 | @end menu | 
 |  | 
 | @node Simple Assignments | 
 | @subsection Simple Assignments | 
 |  | 
 | You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators: | 
 |  | 
 | @table @code | 
 | @item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ; | 
 | @itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ; | 
 | @itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ; | 
 | @itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ; | 
 | @itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ; | 
 | @itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ; | 
 | @itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ; | 
 | @itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ; | 
 | @itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ; | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of | 
 | @var{expression}.  In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be | 
 | defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly. | 
 |  | 
 | The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter.  You | 
 | may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command.  @xref{Location Counter}. | 
 |  | 
 | The semicolon after @var{expression} is required. | 
 |  | 
 | Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}. | 
 |  | 
 | You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as | 
 | statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output | 
 | section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command. | 
 |  | 
 | The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the | 
 | expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}. | 
 |  | 
 | Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol | 
 | assignments may be used: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | floating_point = 0; | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |   .text : | 
 |     @{ | 
 |       *(.text) | 
 |       _etext = .; | 
 |     @} | 
 |   _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3; | 
 |   .data : @{ *(.data) @} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as | 
 | zero.  The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following | 
 | the last @samp{.text} input section.  The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be | 
 | defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned | 
 | upward to a 4 byte boundary. | 
 |  | 
 | @node HIDDEN | 
 | @subsection HIDDEN | 
 | @cindex HIDDEN | 
 | For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be | 
 | exported.  The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}. | 
 |  | 
 | Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use | 
 | @code{HIDDEN}: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | HIDDEN(floating_point = 0); | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |   .text : | 
 |     @{ | 
 |       *(.text) | 
 |       HIDDEN(_etext = .); | 
 |     @} | 
 |   HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3); | 
 |   .data : @{ *(.data) @} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module. | 
 |  | 
 | @node PROVIDE | 
 | @subsection PROVIDE | 
 | @cindex PROVIDE | 
 | In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol | 
 | only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in | 
 | the link.  For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol | 
 | @samp{etext}.  However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use | 
 | @samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error.  The | 
 | @code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as | 
 | @samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined.  The syntax is | 
 | @code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}. | 
 |  | 
 | Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |   .text : | 
 |     @{ | 
 |       *(.text) | 
 |       _etext = .; | 
 |       PROVIDE(etext = .); | 
 |     @} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading | 
 | underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic.  If, | 
 | on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading | 
 | underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program. | 
 | If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the | 
 | linker will use the definition in the linker script. | 
 |  | 
 | Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be | 
 | defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol | 
 | that the @code{PROVIDE} would create.  This is particularly important | 
 | when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as | 
 | @samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols. | 
 |  | 
 | @node PROVIDE_HIDDEN | 
 | @subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN | 
 | @cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN | 
 | Similar to @code{PROVIDE}.  For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be | 
 | hidden and won't be exported. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Source Code Reference | 
 | @subsection Source Code Reference | 
 |  | 
 | Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not | 
 | intuitive.  In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to | 
 | a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a | 
 | symbol that does not have a value. | 
 |  | 
 | Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often | 
 | transform names in the source code into different names when they are | 
 | stored in the symbol table.  For example, Fortran compilers commonly | 
 | prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name | 
 | mangling}.  Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name | 
 | of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same | 
 | variable as it is defined in a linker script.  For example in C a | 
 | linker script variable might be referred to as: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   extern int foo; | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | But in the linker script it might be defined as: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   _foo = 1000; | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name | 
 | transformation has taken place. | 
 |  | 
 | When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two | 
 | things happen.  The first is that the compiler reserves enough space | 
 | in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol.  The | 
 | second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol | 
 | table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}.  ie the symbol table | 
 | contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's | 
 | value.  So for example the following C declaration, at file scope: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   int foo = 1000; | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table.  This entry | 
 | holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the | 
 | number 1000 is initially stored. | 
 |  | 
 | When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that | 
 | first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's | 
 | memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block. | 
 | So: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   foo = 1; | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address | 
 | associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that | 
 | address.  Whereas: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   int * a = & foo; | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address | 
 | and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with | 
 | the variable @samp{a}. | 
 |  | 
 | Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in | 
 | the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them.  Thus they are | 
 | an address without a value.  So for example the linker script definition: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   foo = 1000; | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds | 
 | the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at | 
 | address 1000.  This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a | 
 | linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is | 
 | access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol. | 
 |  | 
 | Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code | 
 | you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to | 
 | use its value.  For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a | 
 | section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the | 
 | linker script contains these declarations: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 |   start_of_ROM   = .ROM; | 
 |   end_of_ROM     = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM); | 
 |   start_of_FLASH = .FLASH; | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Then the C source code to perform the copy would be: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 |   extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH; | 
 |  | 
 |   memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM); | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Note the use of the @samp{&} operators.  These are correct. | 
 | Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or | 
 | arrays and then the code will again work as expected: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 |   extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[]; | 
 |  | 
 |   memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM); | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&} | 
 | operators. | 
 |  | 
 | @node SECTIONS | 
 | @section SECTIONS Command | 
 | @kindex SECTIONS | 
 | The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections | 
 | into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory. | 
 |  | 
 | The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |   @var{sections-command} | 
 |   @var{sections-command} | 
 |   @dots{} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize @bullet | 
 | @item | 
 | an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command}) | 
 | @item | 
 | a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments}) | 
 | @item | 
 | an output section description | 
 | @item | 
 | an overlay description | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the | 
 | @code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in | 
 | those commands.  This can also make the linker script easier to | 
 | understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in | 
 | the layout of the output file. | 
 |  | 
 | Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described | 
 | below. | 
 |  | 
 | If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the | 
 | linker will place each input section into an identically named output | 
 | section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the | 
 | input files.  If all input sections are present in the first file, for | 
 | example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order | 
 | in the first input file.  The first section will be at address zero. | 
 |  | 
 | @menu | 
 | * Output Section Description::	Output section description | 
 | * Output Section Name::		Output section name | 
 | * Output Section Address::	Output section address | 
 | * Input Section::		Input section description | 
 | * Output Section Data::		Output section data | 
 | * Output Section Keywords::	Output section keywords | 
 | * Output Section Discarding::	Output section discarding | 
 | * Output Section Attributes::	Output section attributes | 
 | * Overlay Description::		Overlay description | 
 | @end menu | 
 |  | 
 | @node Output Section Description | 
 | @subsection Output Section Description | 
 | The full description of an output section looks like this: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] : | 
 |   [AT(@var{lma})] | 
 |   [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT] | 
 |   [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})] | 
 |   [@var{constraint}] | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     @var{output-section-command} | 
 |     @var{output-section-command} | 
 |     @dots{} | 
 |   @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,] | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes. | 
 |  | 
 | The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section | 
 | name is unambiguous.  The colon and the curly braces are also required. | 
 | The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and | 
 | the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression. | 
 | The line breaks and other white space are optional. | 
 |  | 
 | Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize @bullet | 
 | @item | 
 | a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments}) | 
 | @item | 
 | an input section description (@pxref{Input Section}) | 
 | @item | 
 | data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data}) | 
 | @item | 
 | a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords}) | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | @node Output Section Name | 
 | @subsection Output Section Name | 
 | @cindex name, section | 
 | @cindex section name | 
 | The name of the output section is @var{section}.  @var{section} must | 
 | meet the constraints of your output format.  In formats which only | 
 | support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name | 
 | must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for | 
 | example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the | 
 | output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not | 
 | names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a | 
 | quoted numeric string.  A section name may consist of any sequence of | 
 | characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as | 
 | commas must be quoted. | 
 |  | 
 | The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section | 
 | Discarding}. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Output Section Address | 
 | @subsection Output Section Address | 
 | @cindex address, section | 
 | @cindex section address | 
 | The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory | 
 | address) of the output section.  This address is optional, but if it | 
 | is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified. | 
 |  | 
 | If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the | 
 | section, based on the heuristic below.  This address will be adjusted | 
 | to fit the alignment requirement of the output section.  The | 
 | alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section | 
 | contained within the output section. | 
 |  | 
 | The output section address heuristic is as follows: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize @bullet | 
 | @item | 
 | If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it | 
 | is added to this region and its address will be the next free address | 
 | in that region. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory | 
 | regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the | 
 | section is selected to contain it.  The section's output address will | 
 | be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then | 
 | the output address will be based on the current value of the location | 
 | counter. | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | @noindent | 
 | For example: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | .text . : @{ *(.text) @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @noindent | 
 | and | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | .text : @{ *(.text) @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @noindent | 
 | are subtly different.  The first will set the address of the | 
 | @samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location | 
 | counter.  The second will set it to the current value of the location | 
 | counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text} | 
 | input sections. | 
 |  | 
 | The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}. | 
 | For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary, | 
 | so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could | 
 | do something like this: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | .text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter | 
 | aligned upward to the specified value. | 
 |  | 
 | Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the | 
 | location counter, provided that the section is non-empty.  (Empty | 
 | sections are ignored). | 
 |  | 
 | @node Input Section | 
 | @subsection Input Section Description | 
 | @cindex input sections | 
 | @cindex mapping input sections to output sections | 
 | The most common output section command is an input section description. | 
 |  | 
 | The input section description is the most basic linker script operation. | 
 | You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program | 
 | in memory.  You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to | 
 | map the input files into your memory layout. | 
 |  | 
 | @menu | 
 | * Input Section Basics::	Input section basics | 
 | * Input Section Wildcards::	Input section wildcard patterns | 
 | * Input Section Common::	Input section for common symbols | 
 | * Input Section Keep::		Input section and garbage collection | 
 | * Input Section Example::	Input section example | 
 | @end menu | 
 |  | 
 | @node Input Section Basics | 
 | @subsubsection Input Section Basics | 
 | @cindex input section basics | 
 | An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed | 
 | by a list of section names in parentheses. | 
 |  | 
 | The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we | 
 | describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}). | 
 |  | 
 | The most common input section description is to include all input | 
 | sections with a particular name in the output section.  For example, to | 
 | include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | *(.text) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name.  To exclude a list | 
 | @cindex EXCLUDE_FILE | 
 | of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to | 
 | match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list.  For | 
 | example: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o} | 
 | and @file{otherfile.o} to be included.  The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be | 
 | placed inside the section list, for example: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | The result of this is identically to the previous example.  Supporting | 
 | two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains | 
 | more than one section, as described below. | 
 |  | 
 | There are two ways to include more than one section: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | *(.text .rdata) | 
 | *(.text) *(.rdata) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and | 
 | @samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section.  In the | 
 | first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as | 
 | they are found in the linker input.  In the second example, all | 
 | @samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all | 
 | @samp{.rdata} input sections. | 
 |  | 
 | When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion | 
 | is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the | 
 | immediately following section, for example: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except | 
 | @file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections | 
 | from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included.  To | 
 | exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example | 
 | could be modified to: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list, | 
 | before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for | 
 | all sections.  Thus the previous example can be rewritten as: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file. | 
 | You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that | 
 | needs to be at a particular location in memory.  For example: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | data.o(.data) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags | 
 | of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used. | 
 |  | 
 | Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | SECTIONS @{ | 
 |   .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @} | 
 |   .text2 :  @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any | 
 | input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags | 
 | @code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set.  The output section | 
 | @samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text) | 
 | whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear. | 
 |  | 
 | You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern | 
 | matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file, | 
 | with no whitespace around the colon. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @samp | 
 | @item archive:file | 
 | matches file within archive | 
 | @item archive: | 
 | matches the whole archive | 
 | @item :file | 
 | matches file but not one in an archive | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell | 
 | wildcards.  On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a | 
 | single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so | 
 | @samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o} | 
 | within an archive called @samp{c}.  @samp{archive:file} filespecs may | 
 | also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in | 
 | other linker script contexts.  For instance, you cannot extract a file | 
 | from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT} | 
 | command. | 
 |  | 
 | If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in | 
 | the input file will be included in the output section.  This is not | 
 | commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion.  For example: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | data.o | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier | 
 | and does not contain any wild card | 
 | characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file | 
 | name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command.  If you | 
 | did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as | 
 | though it appeared on the command line.  Note that this differs from an | 
 | @code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in | 
 | the archive search path. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Input Section Wildcards | 
 | @subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns | 
 | @cindex input section wildcards | 
 | @cindex wildcard file name patterns | 
 | @cindex file name wildcard patterns | 
 | @cindex section name wildcard patterns | 
 | In an input section description, either the file name or the section | 
 | name or both may be wildcard patterns. | 
 |  | 
 | The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard | 
 | pattern for the file name. | 
 |  | 
 | The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @samp | 
 | @item * | 
 | matches any number of characters | 
 | @item ? | 
 | matches any single character | 
 | @item [@var{chars}] | 
 | matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-} | 
 | character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in | 
 | @samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter | 
 | @item \ | 
 | quotes the following character | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly | 
 | specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command.  The linker | 
 | does not search directories to expand wildcards. | 
 |  | 
 | If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name | 
 | appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker | 
 | will use the first match in the linker script.  For example, this | 
 | sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the | 
 | @file{data.o} rule will not be used: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | .data : @{ *(.data) @} | 
 | .data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex SORT_BY_NAME | 
 | Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards | 
 | in the order in which they are seen during the link.  You can change | 
 | this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard | 
 | pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}).  When the | 
 | @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections | 
 | into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT | 
 | @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}. | 
 | @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of | 
 | alignment before placing them in the output file.  Placing larger | 
 | alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding | 
 | needed. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY | 
 | @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}. | 
 | @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending | 
 | numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the | 
 | section name before placing them in the output file.  In | 
 | @code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is | 
 | the init_priority.  In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN}, | 
 | @code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex SORT | 
 | @code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}. | 
 |  | 
 | When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there | 
 | can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands. | 
 |  | 
 | @enumerate | 
 | @item | 
 | @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)). | 
 | It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two | 
 | sections have the same name. | 
 | @item | 
 | @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)). | 
 | It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two | 
 | sections have the same alignment. | 
 | @item | 
 | @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is | 
 | treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern). | 
 | @item | 
 | @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)) | 
 | is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern). | 
 | @item | 
 | All other nested section sorting commands are invalid. | 
 | @end enumerate | 
 |  | 
 | When both command-line section sorting option and linker script | 
 | section sorting command are used, section sorting command always | 
 | takes precedence over the command-line option. | 
 |  | 
 | If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the | 
 | command-line option will make the section sorting command to be | 
 | treated as nested sorting command. | 
 |  | 
 | @enumerate | 
 | @item | 
 | @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with | 
 | @option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to | 
 | @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)). | 
 | @item | 
 | @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with | 
 | @option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to | 
 | @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)). | 
 | @end enumerate | 
 |  | 
 | If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the | 
 | command-line option will be ignored. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex SORT_NONE | 
 | @code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line | 
 | section sorting option. | 
 |  | 
 | If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the | 
 | @samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file.  The map file shows | 
 | precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections. | 
 |  | 
 | This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition | 
 | files.  This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text} | 
 | sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}. | 
 | The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning | 
 | with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the | 
 | linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}. | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | SECTIONS @{ | 
 |   .text : @{ *(.text) @} | 
 |   .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @} | 
 |   .data : @{ *(.data) @} | 
 |   .bss : @{ *(.bss) @} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @node Input Section Common | 
 | @subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols | 
 | @cindex common symbol placement | 
 | @cindex uninitialized data placement | 
 | A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object | 
 | file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section.  The | 
 | linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section | 
 | named @samp{COMMON}. | 
 |  | 
 | You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any | 
 | other input sections.  You can use this to place common symbols from a | 
 | particular input file in one section while common symbols from other | 
 | input files are placed in another section. | 
 |  | 
 | In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the | 
 | @samp{.bss} section in the output file.  For example: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | .bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex scommon section | 
 | @cindex small common symbols | 
 | Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol.  For | 
 | example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common | 
 | symbols and small common symbols.  In this case, the linker will use a | 
 | different special section name for other types of common symbols.  In | 
 | the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common | 
 | symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols.  This permits you | 
 | to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different | 
 | locations. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex [COMMON] | 
 | You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts.  This | 
 | notation is now considered obsolete.  It is equivalent to | 
 | @samp{*(COMMON)}. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Input Section Keep | 
 | @subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection | 
 | @cindex KEEP | 
 | @cindex garbage collection | 
 | When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}), | 
 | it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated. | 
 | This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry | 
 | with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or | 
 | @code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Input Section Example | 
 | @subsubsection Input Section Example | 
 | The following example is a complete linker script.  It tells the linker | 
 | to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the | 
 | start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location | 
 | @samp{0x10000}.  All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o} | 
 | follows immediately, in the same output section.  All of section | 
 | @samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section | 
 | @samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}. | 
 | All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any | 
 | files are written to output section @samp{outputc}. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | SECTIONS @{ | 
 |   outputa 0x10000 : | 
 |     @{ | 
 |     all.o | 
 |     foo.o (.input1) | 
 |     @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @group | 
 |   outputb : | 
 |     @{ | 
 |     foo.o (.input2) | 
 |     foo1.o (.input1) | 
 |     @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @group | 
 |   outputc : | 
 |     @{ | 
 |     *(.input1) | 
 |     *(.input2) | 
 |     @} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name | 
 | and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will | 
 | automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and | 
 | __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section.  These | 
 | indicate the start address and end address of the output section | 
 | respectively.  Note: most section names are not representable as | 
 | C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Output Section Data | 
 | @subsection Output Section Data | 
 | @cindex data | 
 | @cindex section data | 
 | @cindex output section data | 
 | @kindex ASCIZ ``@var{string}'' | 
 | @kindex BYTE(@var{expression}) | 
 | @kindex SHORT(@var{expression}) | 
 | @kindex LONG(@var{expression}) | 
 | @kindex QUAD(@var{expression}) | 
 | @kindex SQUAD(@var{expression}) | 
 | You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using | 
 | @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as | 
 | an output section command.  Each keyword is followed by an expression in | 
 | parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}).  The | 
 | value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location | 
 | counter. | 
 |  | 
 | The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands | 
 | store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively).  After storing the | 
 | bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes | 
 | stored. | 
 |  | 
 | For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value | 
 | of the symbol @samp{addr}: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | BYTE(1) | 
 | LONG(addr) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the | 
 | same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value.  When both host and | 
 | target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits.  In this case | 
 | @code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and | 
 | @code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits. | 
 |  | 
 | If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness, | 
 | which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness. | 
 | When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is | 
 | true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the | 
 | endianness of the first input object file. | 
 |  | 
 | You can include a zero-terminated string in an output section by using | 
 | @code{ASCIZ}.  The keyword is followed by a string which is stored at | 
 | the current value of the location counter adding a zero byte at the | 
 | end.  If the string includes spaces it must be enclosed in double | 
 | quotes.  The string may contain '\n', '\r', '\t' and octal numbers. | 
 | Hex numbers are not supported. | 
 |  | 
 | For example, this string of 16 characters will create a 17 byte area | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   ASCIZ "This is 16 bytes" | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not | 
 | between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@ | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | whereas this will work: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@ | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex FILL(@var{expression}) | 
 | @cindex holes, filling | 
 | @cindex unspecified memory | 
 | You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the | 
 | current section.  It is followed by an expression in parentheses.  Any | 
 | otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example, | 
 | gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled | 
 | with the value of the expression, repeated as | 
 | necessary.  A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the | 
 | point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more | 
 | than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in | 
 | different parts of an output section. | 
 |  | 
 | This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the | 
 | value @samp{0x90}: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | FILL(0x90909090) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output | 
 | section attribute, but it only affects the | 
 | part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the | 
 | entire section.  If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes | 
 | precedence.  @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill | 
 | expression. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex LINKER_VERSION | 
 | @cindex LINKER_VERSION | 
 | Inserts a string containing the version of the linker at the current | 
 | point.  Note - by default this directive is disabled and will do | 
 | nothing.  It only becomes active if the | 
 | @option{--enable-linker-version} command line option is used. | 
 |  | 
 | Built-in linker scripts for ELF based targets already include this | 
 | directive in their @samp{.comment} section. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Output Section Keywords | 
 | @subsection Output Section Keywords | 
 | There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section | 
 | commands. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @code | 
 | @kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS | 
 | @cindex input filename symbols | 
 | @cindex filename symbols | 
 | @item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS | 
 | The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file. | 
 | The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input | 
 | file.  The section of each symbol will be the output section in which | 
 | the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears. | 
 |  | 
 | This is conventional for the a.out object file format.  It is not | 
 | normally used for any other object file format. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex CONSTRUCTORS | 
 | @cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link | 
 | @cindex constructors, arranging in link | 
 | @item CONSTRUCTORS | 
 | When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an | 
 | unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and | 
 | destructors.  When linking object file formats which do not support | 
 | arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will | 
 | automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name. | 
 | For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the | 
 | linker to place constructor information in the output section where the | 
 | @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears.  The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is | 
 | ignored for other object file formats. | 
 |  | 
 | The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global | 
 | constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end. | 
 | Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark | 
 | the start and end of the global destructors.  The | 
 | first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address | 
 | of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word.  The | 
 | compiler must arrange to actually run the code.  For these object file | 
 | formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine | 
 | @code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into | 
 | the startup code for @code{main}.  @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs | 
 | destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function | 
 | @code{exit}. | 
 |  | 
 | For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support | 
 | arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the | 
 | addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors} | 
 | and @code{.dtors} sections.  Placing the following sequence into your | 
 | linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++ | 
 | runtime code expects to see. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |       __CTOR_LIST__ = .; | 
 |       LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2) | 
 |       *(.ctors) | 
 |       LONG(0) | 
 |       __CTOR_END__ = .; | 
 |       __DTOR_LIST__ = .; | 
 |       LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2) | 
 |       *(.dtors) | 
 |       LONG(0) | 
 |       __DTOR_END__ = .; | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority, | 
 | which provides some control over the order in which global constructors | 
 | are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they | 
 | are executed in the correct order.  When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} | 
 | command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead.  When using the | 
 | @code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and | 
 | @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and | 
 | @samp{*(.dtors)}. | 
 |  | 
 | Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically, | 
 | and you will not need to concern yourself with them.  However, you may | 
 | need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker | 
 | scripts. | 
 |  | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @node Output Section Discarding | 
 | @subsection Output Section Discarding | 
 | @cindex discarding sections | 
 | @cindex sections, discarding | 
 | @cindex removing sections | 
 | The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents. | 
 | This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or | 
 | may not be present in any of the input files.  For example: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | .foo : @{ *(.foo) @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a | 
 | @samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input | 
 | sections are not all empty.  Other link script directives that allocate | 
 | space in an output section will also create the output section.  So | 
 | too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create | 
 | space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym}, | 
 | @samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when | 
 | @samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script. | 
 | This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}. | 
 |  | 
 | The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address}) | 
 | on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines | 
 | symbols in the output section.  In that case the linker will obey | 
 | the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the | 
 | section is discarded. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex /DISCARD/ | 
 | The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard | 
 | input sections.  Any input sections which are assigned to an output | 
 | section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file. | 
 |  | 
 | This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag | 
 | @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker | 
 | garbage collection. | 
 |  | 
 | Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be | 
 | discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other | 
 | members which are not being discarded.  This is deliberate. | 
 | Discarding takes precedence over grouping. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Output Section Attributes | 
 | @subsection Output Section Attributes | 
 | @cindex output section attributes | 
 | We showed above that the full description of an output section looked | 
 | like this: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] : | 
 |   [AT(@var{lma})] | 
 |   [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT] | 
 |   [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})] | 
 |   [@var{constraint}] | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     @var{output-section-command} | 
 |     @var{output-section-command} | 
 |     @dots{} | 
 |   @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and | 
 | @var{output-section-command}.  In this section we will describe the | 
 | remaining section attributes. | 
 |  | 
 | @menu | 
 | * Output Section Type::		Output section type | 
 | * Output Section LMA::		Output section LMA | 
 | * Forced Output Alignment::	Forced Output Alignment | 
 | * Forced Input Alignment::	Forced Input Alignment | 
 | * Output Section Constraint::   Output section constraint | 
 | * Output Section Region::	Output section region | 
 | * Output Section Phdr::		Output section phdr | 
 | * Output Section Fill::		Output section fill | 
 | @end menu | 
 |  | 
 | @node Output Section Type | 
 | @subsubsection Output Section Type | 
 | Each output section may have a type.  The type is a keyword in | 
 | parentheses.  The following types are defined: | 
 |  | 
 | @table @code | 
 |  | 
 | @item NOLOAD | 
 | The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be | 
 | loaded into memory when the program is run. | 
 |  | 
 | @item READONLY | 
 | The section should be marked as read-only. | 
 |  | 
 | @item DSECT | 
 | @item COPY | 
 | @item INFO | 
 | @item OVERLAY | 
 | These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are | 
 | rarely used.  They all have the same effect: the section should be | 
 | marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the | 
 | section when the program is run. | 
 |  | 
 | @item TYPE = @var{type} | 
 | Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF | 
 | output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB}, | 
 | @code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY}, | 
 | @code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed | 
 | for @var{type}.  It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any | 
 | special requirements of the section type are met. | 
 |  | 
 | Note - the TYPE only is used if some or all of the contents of the | 
 | section do not have an implicit type of their own.  So for example: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ *(.bar) @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | will set the type of section @samp{.foo} to the type of the section | 
 | @samp{.bar} in the input files, which may not be the SHT_PROGBITS | 
 | type.  Whereas: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1) @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | will set the type of @samp{.foo} to SHT_PROGBBITS.  If it is necessary | 
 | to override the type of incoming sections and force the output section | 
 | type then an extra piece of untyped data will be needed: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1); *(.bar) @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} ) | 
 | This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the | 
 | type specified by @var{type}. | 
 |  | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex NOLOAD | 
 | @cindex prevent unnecessary loading | 
 | @cindex loading, preventing | 
 | The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on | 
 | the input sections which map into it.  You can override this by using | 
 | the section type.  For example, in the script sample below, the | 
 | @samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not | 
 | need to be loaded when the program is run. | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | SECTIONS @{ | 
 |   ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @} | 
 |   @dots{} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @node Output Section LMA | 
 | @subsubsection Output Section LMA | 
 | @kindex AT>@var{lma_region} | 
 | @kindex AT(@var{lma}) | 
 | @cindex load address | 
 | @cindex section load address | 
 | Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see | 
 | @ref{Basic Script Concepts}.  The virtual address is specified by the | 
 | @pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier.  The load address is | 
 | specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords.  Specifying a load | 
 | address is optional. | 
 |  | 
 | The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument.  This | 
 | specifies the exact load address of the section.  The @code{AT>} keyword | 
 | takes the name of a memory region as an argument.  @xref{MEMORY}.  The | 
 | load address of the section is set to the next free address in the | 
 | region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements. | 
 |  | 
 | If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable | 
 | section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the | 
 | load address: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize @bullet | 
 | @item | 
 | If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as | 
 | the LMA address as well. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible | 
 | with the current section, and this region contains at least one | 
 | section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the | 
 | VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of | 
 | the last section in the located region. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | If no memory regions have been declared then a default region | 
 | that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous | 
 | section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA. | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex ROM initialized data | 
 | @cindex initialized data in ROM | 
 | This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image.  For | 
 | example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one | 
 | called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called | 
 | @samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section | 
 | even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold | 
 | uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}.  The symbol @code{_data} is | 
 | defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location | 
 | counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 |   @{ | 
 |   .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @} | 
 |   .mdata 0x2000 : | 
 |     AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) ) | 
 |     @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ;  @} | 
 |   .bss 0x3000 : | 
 |     @{ _bstart = . ;  *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with | 
 | this linker script would include something like the following, to copy | 
 | the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address.  Notice | 
 | how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker | 
 | script. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend; | 
 | char *src = &_etext; | 
 | char *dst = &_data; | 
 |  | 
 | /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it.  */ | 
 | while (dst < &_edata) | 
 |   *dst++ = *src++; | 
 |  | 
 | /* Zero bss.  */ | 
 | for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++) | 
 |   *dst = 0; | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @node Forced Output Alignment | 
 | @subsubsection Forced Output Alignment | 
 | @kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | 
 | @cindex forcing output section alignment | 
 | @cindex output section alignment | 
 | You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN.  As an | 
 | alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains | 
 | intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Forced Input Alignment | 
 | @subsubsection Forced Input Alignment | 
 | @kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align}) | 
 | @cindex forcing input section alignment | 
 | @cindex input section alignment | 
 | You can force input section alignment within an output section by using | 
 | SUBALIGN.  The value specified overrides any alignment given by input | 
 | sections, whether larger or smaller. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Output Section Constraint | 
 | @subsubsection Output Section Constraint | 
 | @kindex ONLY_IF_RO | 
 | @kindex ONLY_IF_RW | 
 | @cindex constraints on output sections | 
 | You can specify that an output section should only be created if all | 
 | of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are | 
 | read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and | 
 | @code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Output Section Region | 
 | @subsubsection Output Section Region | 
 | @kindex >@var{region} | 
 | @cindex section, assigning to memory region | 
 | @cindex memory regions and sections | 
 | You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by | 
 | using @samp{>@var{region}}.  @xref{MEMORY}. | 
 |  | 
 | Here is a simple example: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @} | 
 | SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @node Output Section Phdr | 
 | @subsubsection Output Section Phdr | 
 | @kindex :@var{phdr} | 
 | @cindex section, assigning to program header | 
 | @cindex program headers and sections | 
 | You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by | 
 | using @samp{:@var{phdr}}.  @xref{PHDRS}.  If a section is assigned to | 
 | one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be | 
 | assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly | 
 | @code{:@var{phdr}} modifier.  You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the | 
 | linker to not put the section in any segment at all. | 
 |  | 
 | Here is a simple example: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @} | 
 | SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @node Output Section Fill | 
 | @subsubsection Output Section Fill | 
 | @kindex =@var{fillexp} | 
 | @cindex section fill pattern | 
 | @cindex fill pattern, entire section | 
 | You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using | 
 | @samp{=@var{fillexp}}.  @var{fillexp} is an expression | 
 | (@pxref{Expressions}).  Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory | 
 | within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required | 
 | alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as | 
 | necessary.  If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string | 
 | of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then | 
 | an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the | 
 | fill pattern;  Leading zeros become part of the pattern too.  For all | 
 | other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill | 
 | pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the | 
 | expression.  In all cases, the number is big-endian. | 
 |  | 
 | You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the | 
 | output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}). | 
 |  | 
 | Here is a simple example: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @node Overlay Description | 
 | @subsection Overlay Description | 
 | @kindex OVERLAY | 
 | @cindex overlays | 
 | An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which | 
 | are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at | 
 | the same memory address.  At run time, some sort of overlay manager will | 
 | copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as | 
 | required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits.  This approach | 
 | can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster | 
 | than another. | 
 |  | 
 | Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command.  The | 
 | @code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an | 
 | output section description.  The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY} | 
 | command is as follows: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )] | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     @var{secname1} | 
 |       @{ | 
 |         @var{output-section-command} | 
 |         @var{output-section-command} | 
 |         @dots{} | 
 |       @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] | 
 |     @var{secname2} | 
 |       @{ | 
 |         @var{output-section-command} | 
 |         @var{output-section-command} | 
 |         @dots{} | 
 |       @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] | 
 |     @dots{} | 
 |   @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,] | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each | 
 | section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above).  The | 
 | section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to | 
 | those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}), | 
 | except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for | 
 | sections within an @code{OVERLAY}. | 
 |  | 
 | The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and | 
 | the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression. | 
 |  | 
 | The sections are all defined with the same starting address.  The load | 
 | addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in | 
 | memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a | 
 | whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional, | 
 | and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional, | 
 | and defaults to the current value of the location counter). | 
 |  | 
 | If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any | 
 | references among the sections, the linker will report an error.  Since | 
 | the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make | 
 | sense for one section to refer directly to another. | 
 | @xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}. | 
 |  | 
 | For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically | 
 | provides two symbols.  The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is | 
 | defined as the starting load address of the section.  The symbol | 
 | @code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of | 
 | the section.  Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal | 
 | within C identifiers are removed.  C (or assembler) code may use these | 
 | symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary. | 
 |  | 
 | At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to | 
 | the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section. | 
 |  | 
 | Here is an example.  Remember that this would appear inside a | 
 | @code{SECTIONS} construct. | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 |   OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) | 
 |    @{ | 
 |      .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @} | 
 |      .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @} | 
 |    @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at | 
 | address 0x1000.  @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and | 
 | @samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}.  The | 
 | following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0}, | 
 | @code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1}, | 
 | @code{__load_stop_text1}. | 
 |  | 
 | C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look | 
 | like the following. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 |   extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1; | 
 |   memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1, | 
 |           &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1); | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since | 
 | everything it does can be done using the more basic commands.  The above | 
 | example could have been written identically as follows. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 |   .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @} | 
 |   PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0)); | 
 |   PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0)); | 
 |   .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @} | 
 |   PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1)); | 
 |   PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1)); | 
 |   . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1)); | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @node MEMORY | 
 | @section MEMORY Command | 
 | @kindex MEMORY | 
 | @cindex memory regions | 
 | @cindex regions of memory | 
 | @cindex allocating memory | 
 | @cindex discontinuous memory | 
 | The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available | 
 | memory.  You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command. | 
 |  | 
 | The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of | 
 | memory in the target.  You can use it to describe which memory regions | 
 | may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid.  You | 
 | can then assign sections to particular memory regions.  The linker will | 
 | set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about | 
 | regions that become too full.  The linker will not shuffle sections | 
 | around to fit into the available regions. | 
 |  | 
 | A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command, | 
 | however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were | 
 | specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command.  The syntax for | 
 | @code{MEMORY} is: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | MEMORY | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len} | 
 |     @dots{} | 
 |   @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the | 
 | region.  The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script. | 
 | Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict | 
 | with symbol names, file names, or section names.  Each memory region | 
 | must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command.  However you can | 
 | add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS} | 
 | command. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex memory region attributes | 
 | The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify | 
 | whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is | 
 | not explicitly mapped in the linker script.  As described in | 
 | @ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input | 
 | section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as | 
 | the input section.  If you define region attributes, the linker will use | 
 | them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates. | 
 |  | 
 | The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters: | 
 | @table @samp | 
 | @item R | 
 | Read-only section | 
 | @item W | 
 | Read/write section | 
 | @item X | 
 | Executable section | 
 | @item A | 
 | Allocatable section | 
 | @item I | 
 | Initialized section | 
 | @item L | 
 | Same as @samp{I} | 
 | @item ! | 
 | Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than | 
 | @samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region.  The @samp{!} | 
 | attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an | 
 | unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does | 
 | not match any of the attributes listed afterwards.  Thus an attribute | 
 | string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either | 
 | or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as | 
 | the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex ORIGIN = | 
 | @kindex o = | 
 | @kindex org = | 
 | The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of | 
 | the memory region.  The expression must evaluate to a constant and it | 
 | cannot involve any symbols.  The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be | 
 | abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example, | 
 | @code{ORG}). | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex LENGTH = | 
 | @kindex len = | 
 | @kindex l = | 
 | The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory | 
 | region.  As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must | 
 | be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant.  The keyword | 
 | @code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}. | 
 |  | 
 | In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions | 
 | available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes, | 
 | and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes.  The | 
 | linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which | 
 | is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only | 
 | or executable.  The linker will place other sections which are not | 
 | explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory | 
 | region. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | MEMORY | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     rom (rx)  : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K | 
 |     ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M | 
 |   @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place | 
 | specific output sections into that memory region by using the | 
 | @samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute.  For example, if you have | 
 | a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the | 
 | output section definition.  @xref{Output Section Region}.  If no address | 
 | was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to | 
 | the next available address within the memory region.  If the combined | 
 | output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the | 
 | region, the linker will issue an error message. | 
 |  | 
 | It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an | 
 | expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and | 
 | @code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 |   _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4; | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @node PHDRS | 
 | @section PHDRS Command | 
 | @kindex PHDRS | 
 | @cindex program headers | 
 | @cindex ELF program headers | 
 | @cindex program segments | 
 | @cindex segments, ELF | 
 | The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as | 
 | @dfn{segments}.  The program headers describe how the program should be | 
 | loaded into memory.  You can print them out by using the @code{objdump} | 
 | program with the @samp{-p} option. | 
 |  | 
 | When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader | 
 | reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the | 
 | program.  This will only work if the program headers are set correctly. | 
 | This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader | 
 | interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI. | 
 |  | 
 | The linker will create reasonable program headers by default.  However, | 
 | in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more | 
 | precisely.  You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose.  When | 
 | the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will | 
 | not create any program headers other than the ones specified. | 
 |  | 
 | The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when | 
 | generating an ELF output file.  In other cases, the linker will simply | 
 | ignore @code{PHDRS}. | 
 |  | 
 | This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command.  The words @code{PHDRS}, | 
 | @code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | PHDRS | 
 | @{ | 
 |   @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ] | 
 |         [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ; | 
 | @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command | 
 | of the linker script.  It is not put into the output file.  Program | 
 | header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict | 
 | with symbol names, file names, or section names.  Each program header | 
 | must have a distinct name.  The headers are processed in order and it | 
 | is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order. | 
 |  | 
 | Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the | 
 | system loader will load from the file.  In the linker script, you | 
 | specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output | 
 | sections in the segments.  You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section | 
 | attribute to place a section in a particular segment.  @xref{Output | 
 | Section Phdr}. | 
 |  | 
 | It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment.  This | 
 | merely implies that one segment of memory contains another.  You may | 
 | repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should | 
 | contain the section. | 
 |  | 
 | If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}}, | 
 | then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do | 
 | not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments.  This is for | 
 | convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be | 
 | placed in a single segment.  You can use @code{:NONE} to override the | 
 | default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any | 
 | segment at all. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex FILEHDR | 
 | @kindex PHDRS | 
 | You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after | 
 | the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment. | 
 | The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF | 
 | file header.  The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should | 
 | include the ELF program headers themselves.  If applied to a loadable | 
 | segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of | 
 | these keywords. | 
 |  | 
 | The @var{type} may be one of the following.  The numbers indicate the | 
 | value of the keyword. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @asis | 
 | @item @code{PT_NULL} (0) | 
 | Indicates an unused program header. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @code{PT_LOAD} (1) | 
 | Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from | 
 | the file. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2) | 
 | Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @code{PT_INTERP} (3) | 
 | Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be | 
 | found. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @code{PT_NOTE} (4) | 
 | Indicates a segment holding note information. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5) | 
 | A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF | 
 | ABI. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @code{PT_PHDR} (6) | 
 | Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @code{PT_TLS} (7) | 
 | Indicates a segment containing thread local storage. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @var{expression} | 
 | An expression giving the numeric type of the program header.  This may | 
 | be used for types not defined above. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address | 
 | in memory by using an @code{AT} expression.  This is identical to the | 
 | @code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output | 
 | Section LMA}).  The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the | 
 | output section attribute. | 
 |  | 
 | The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections | 
 | which comprise the segment.  You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to | 
 | explicitly specify the segment flags.  The value of @var{flags} must be | 
 | an integer.  It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program | 
 | header. | 
 |  | 
 | Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}.  This shows a typical set of program | 
 | headers used on a native ELF system. | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | @group | 
 | PHDRS | 
 | @{ | 
 |   headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ; | 
 |   interp PT_INTERP ; | 
 |   text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ; | 
 |   data PT_LOAD ; | 
 |   dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ; | 
 | @} | 
 |  | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |   . = SIZEOF_HEADERS; | 
 |   .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp | 
 |   .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text | 
 |   .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */ | 
 |   @dots{} | 
 |   . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */ | 
 |   .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data | 
 |   .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic | 
 |   @dots{} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | @node VERSION | 
 | @section VERSION Command | 
 | @kindex VERSION @{script text@} | 
 | @cindex symbol versions | 
 | @cindex version script | 
 | @cindex versions of symbols | 
 | The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF.  Symbol versions are | 
 | only useful when using shared libraries.  The dynamic linker can use | 
 | symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs | 
 | a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the | 
 | shared library. | 
 |  | 
 | You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or | 
 | you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script.  You can | 
 | also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option. | 
 |  | 
 | The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | VERSION @{ version-script-commands @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by | 
 | Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5.  The version script defines a tree of | 
 | version nodes.  You specify the node names and interdependencies in the | 
 | version script.  You can specify which symbols are bound to which | 
 | version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local | 
 | scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared | 
 | library. | 
 |  | 
 | The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few | 
 | examples. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | VERS_1.1 @{ | 
 | 	 global: | 
 | 		 foo1; | 
 | 	 local: | 
 | 		 old*; | 
 | 		 original*; | 
 | 		 new*; | 
 | @}; | 
 |  | 
 | VERS_1.2 @{ | 
 | 		 foo2; | 
 | @} VERS_1.1; | 
 |  | 
 | VERS_2.0 @{ | 
 | 		 bar1; bar2; | 
 | 	 extern "C++" @{ | 
 | 		 ns::*; | 
 | 		 "f(int, double)"; | 
 | 	 @}; | 
 | @} VERS_1.2; | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | This example version script defines three version nodes.  The first | 
 | version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies. | 
 | The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}.  It reduces | 
 | a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside | 
 | of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any | 
 | symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new} | 
 | is matched.  The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used | 
 | in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing''). | 
 | However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the | 
 | name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern. | 
 |  | 
 | Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}.  This node | 
 | depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}.  The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2} | 
 | to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}. | 
 |  | 
 | Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}.  This node | 
 | depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}.  The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1} | 
 | and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}. | 
 |  | 
 | When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not | 
 | specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an | 
 | unspecified base version of the library.  You can bind all otherwise | 
 | unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;} | 
 | somewhere in the version script.  Note that it's slightly crazy to use | 
 | wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node.  Global | 
 | wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the | 
 | set exported for an old version.  That's wrong since older versions | 
 | ought to have a fixed set of symbols. | 
 |  | 
 | The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what | 
 | they might suggest to the person reading them.  The @samp{2.0} version | 
 | could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}. | 
 | However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script. | 
 |  | 
 | Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node | 
 | in the version script.  Such version script doesn't assign any versions to | 
 | symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which | 
 | won't. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @}; | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned | 
 | symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it | 
 | requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each | 
 | shared library it is linked against.  Thus at runtime, the dynamic | 
 | loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have | 
 | linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the | 
 | application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols.  In this | 
 | way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that | 
 | all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to | 
 | search for each symbol reference. | 
 |  | 
 | The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of | 
 | doing minor version checking that SunOS does.  The fundamental problem | 
 | that is being addressed here is that typically references to external | 
 | functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when | 
 | the application starts up.  If a shared library is out of date, a | 
 | required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use | 
 | that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail.  With symbol | 
 | versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if | 
 | the libraries being used with the application are too old. | 
 |  | 
 | There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach.  The | 
 | first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the | 
 | source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning | 
 | script.  This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library | 
 | maintainer.  You can do this by putting something like: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1"); | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | in the C source file.  This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to | 
 | be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}. | 
 | The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol | 
 | @samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive | 
 | takes precedence over a version script. | 
 |  | 
 | The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same | 
 | function to appear in a given shared library.  In this way you can make | 
 | an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major | 
 | version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications | 
 | linked against the old interface to continue to function. | 
 |  | 
 | To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the | 
 | source file.  Here is an example: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@"); | 
 | __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1"); | 
 | __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2"); | 
 | __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0"); | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the | 
 | unspecified base version of the symbol.  The source file that contains this | 
 | example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo}, | 
 | @samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}. | 
 |  | 
 | When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be | 
 | some way to specify a default version to which external references to | 
 | this symbol will be bound.  You can do this with the | 
 | @samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive.  You can only | 
 | declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise | 
 | you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol. | 
 |  | 
 | If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol | 
 | within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience | 
 | (i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to | 
 | specifically bind to an external version of the function in question. | 
 |  | 
 | You can also specify the language in the version script: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}. | 
 | The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and | 
 | demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the | 
 | patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}.  The default | 
 | @samp{lang} is @samp{C}. | 
 |  | 
 | Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters.  As | 
 | described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names, | 
 | or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly.  In | 
 | the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing | 
 | whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will | 
 | cause a mismatch.  As the exact string generated by the demangler | 
 | might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you | 
 | should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you | 
 | expect when you upgrade. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Expressions | 
 | @section Expressions in Linker Scripts | 
 | @cindex expressions | 
 | @cindex arithmetic | 
 | The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to | 
 | that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some | 
 | places to resolve syntactic ambiguities.  All expressions are | 
 | evaluated as integers.  All expressions are evaluated in the same | 
 | size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is | 
 | otherwise 64 bits. | 
 |  | 
 | You can use and set symbol values in expressions. | 
 |  | 
 | The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in | 
 | expressions. | 
 |  | 
 | @menu | 
 | * Constants::			Constants | 
 | * Symbolic Constants::          Symbolic constants | 
 | * Symbols::			Symbol Names | 
 | * Orphan Sections::		Orphan Sections | 
 | * Location Counter::		The Location Counter | 
 | * Operators::			Operators | 
 | * Evaluation::			Evaluation | 
 | * Expression Section::		The Section of an Expression | 
 | * Builtin Functions::		Builtin Functions | 
 | @end menu | 
 |  | 
 | @node Constants | 
 | @subsection Constants | 
 | @cindex integer notation | 
 | @cindex constants in linker scripts | 
 | All constants are integers. | 
 |  | 
 | As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be | 
 | octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be | 
 | hexadecimal.  Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or | 
 | @samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or | 
 | @samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal.  Any integer | 
 | value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex scaled integers | 
 | @cindex K and M integer suffixes | 
 | @cindex M and K integer suffixes | 
 | @cindex suffixes for integers | 
 | @cindex integer suffixes | 
 | In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a | 
 | constant by | 
 | @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL | 
 | @ifnottex | 
 | @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL | 
 | @code{1024} or @code{1024*1024} | 
 | @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL | 
 | @end ifnottex | 
 | @tex | 
 | ${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$ | 
 | @end tex | 
 | @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL | 
 | respectively.  For example, the following | 
 | all refer to the same quantity: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | _fourk_1 = 4K; | 
 | _fourk_2 = 4096; | 
 | _fourk_3 = 0x1000; | 
 | _fourk_4 = 10000o; | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in | 
 | conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Symbolic Constants | 
 | @subsection Symbolic Constants | 
 | @cindex symbolic constants | 
 | @kindex CONSTANT | 
 | It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of | 
 | the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of: | 
 |  | 
 | @table @code | 
 | @item MAXPAGESIZE | 
 | @kindex MAXPAGESIZE | 
 | The target's maximum page size. | 
 |  | 
 | @item COMMONPAGESIZE | 
 | @kindex COMMONPAGESIZE | 
 | The target's default page size. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | So for example: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary | 
 | supported by the target. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Symbols | 
 | @subsection Symbol Names | 
 | @cindex symbol names | 
 | @cindex names | 
 | @cindex quoted symbol names | 
 | @kindex " | 
 | Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period | 
 | and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens. | 
 | Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords.  You can | 
 | specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a | 
 | keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | "SECTION" = 9; | 
 | "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10; | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest | 
 | to delimit symbols with spaces.  For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol, | 
 | whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Orphan Sections | 
 | @subsection Orphan Sections | 
 | @cindex orphan | 
 | Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which | 
 | are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker | 
 | script.  The linker will still copy these sections into the | 
 | output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section | 
 | in which to place the orphaned input section. | 
 |  | 
 | If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of | 
 | an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be | 
 | placed at the end of that output section. | 
 |  | 
 | If there is no output section with a matching name then new output | 
 | sections will be created.  Each new output section will have the same | 
 | name as the orphan section placed within it.  If there are multiple | 
 | orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into | 
 | one new output section. | 
 |  | 
 | If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections, | 
 | then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections | 
 | in relation to existing output sections.  On most modern targets, the | 
 | linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same | 
 | attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc.  If no | 
 | sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this | 
 | support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file. | 
 |  | 
 | The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique} | 
 | (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which | 
 | output sections an orphan is placed in. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Location Counter | 
 | @subsection The Location Counter | 
 | @kindex . | 
 | @cindex dot | 
 | @cindex location counter | 
 | @cindex current output location | 
 | The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the | 
 | current output location counter.  Since the @code{.} always refers to a | 
 | location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression | 
 | within a @code{SECTIONS} command.  The @code{.} symbol may appear | 
 | anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex holes | 
 | Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be | 
 | moved.  This may be used to create holes in the output section.  The | 
 | location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section, | 
 | and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so | 
 | doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |   output : | 
 |     @{ | 
 |       file1(.text) | 
 |       . = . + 1000; | 
 |       file2(.text) | 
 |       . += 1000; | 
 |       file3(.text) | 
 |     @} = 0x12345678; | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is | 
 | located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}.  It is | 
 | followed by a 1000 byte gap.  Then the @samp{.text} section from | 
 | @file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the | 
 | @samp{.text} section from @file{file3}.  The notation @samp{= 0x12345678} | 
 | specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}). | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex dot inside sections | 
 | Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the | 
 | current containing object.  Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS} | 
 | statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an | 
 | absolute address.  If @code{.} is used inside a section description | 
 | however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section, | 
 | not an absolute address.  Thus in a script like this: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |     . = 0x100 | 
 |     .text: @{ | 
 |       *(.text) | 
 |       . = 0x200 | 
 |     @} | 
 |     . = 0x500 | 
 |     .data: @{ | 
 |       *(.data) | 
 |       . += 0x600 | 
 |     @} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100 | 
 | and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in | 
 | the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area.  (If there is too | 
 | much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to | 
 | move @code{.} backwards).  The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500 | 
 | and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of | 
 | the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of | 
 | the @samp{.data} output section itself. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex dot outside sections | 
 | Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an | 
 | output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker | 
 | needs to place orphan sections.  For example, given the following: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |     start_of_text = . ; | 
 |     .text: @{ *(.text) @} | 
 |     end_of_text = . ; | 
 |  | 
 |     start_of_data = . ; | 
 |     .data: @{ *(.data) @} | 
 |     end_of_data = . ; | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata}, | 
 | not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section | 
 | between @code{.text} and @code{.data}.  You might think the linker | 
 | should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but | 
 | blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker.  As well, | 
 | the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their | 
 | sections.  Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other | 
 | statements belong to the previous output section, except for the | 
 | special case of an assignment to @code{.}.  I.e., the linker will | 
 | place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written | 
 | as follows: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |     start_of_text = . ; | 
 |     .text: @{ *(.text) @} | 
 |     end_of_text = . ; | 
 |  | 
 |     start_of_data = . ; | 
 |     .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @} | 
 |     .data: @{ *(.data) @} | 
 |     end_of_data = . ; | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of | 
 | @code{start_of_data}.  One way to influence the orphan section | 
 | placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker | 
 | assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of | 
 | a following output section and thus should be grouped with that | 
 | section.  So you could write: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |     start_of_text = . ; | 
 |     .text: @{ *(.text) @} | 
 |     end_of_text = . ; | 
 |  | 
 |     . = . ; | 
 |     start_of_data = . ; | 
 |     .data: @{ *(.data) @} | 
 |     end_of_data = . ; | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between | 
 | @code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}. | 
 |  | 
 | @need 2000 | 
 | @node Operators | 
 | @subsection Operators | 
 | @cindex operators for arithmetic | 
 | @cindex arithmetic operators | 
 | @cindex precedence in expressions | 
 | The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with | 
 | the standard bindings and precedence levels: | 
 | @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL | 
 | @ifnottex | 
 | @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | precedence      associativity   Operators                Notes | 
 | (highest) | 
 | 1               left            !  -  ~                  (1) | 
 | 2               left            *  /  % | 
 | 3               left            +  - | 
 | 4               left            >>  << | 
 | 5               left            ==  !=  >  <  <=  >= | 
 | 6               left            & | 
 | 7               left            | | 
 | 8               left            && | 
 | 9               left            || | 
 | 10              right           ? : | 
 | 11              right           &=  +=  -=  *=  /=       (2) | 
 | (lowest) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | Notes: | 
 | (1) Prefix operators | 
 | (2) @xref{Assignments}. | 
 | @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL | 
 | @end ifnottex | 
 | @tex | 
 | \vskip \baselineskip | 
 | %"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample | 
 | \hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip | 
 | \hrule | 
 | \halign | 
 | {\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr | 
 | height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr | 
 | &Precedence&&  Associativity  &&{\rm Operators}&\cr | 
 | height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr | 
 | \noalign{\hrule} | 
 | height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr | 
 | &highest&&&&&\cr | 
 | % '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font | 
 | &1&&left&&\qquad-          \char'176\      !\qquad\dag&\cr | 
 | &2&&left&&*          /        \%&\cr | 
 | &3&&left&&+          -&\cr | 
 | &4&&left&&>>         <<&\cr | 
 | &5&&left&&==         !=       >      <      <=      >=&\cr | 
 | &6&&left&&\&&\cr | 
 | &7&&left&&|&\cr | 
 | &8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr | 
 | &9&&left&&||&\cr | 
 | &10&&right&&?        :&\cr | 
 | &11&&right&&\qquad\&=      +=       -=     *=     /=\qquad\ddag&\cr | 
 | &lowest&&&&&\cr | 
 | height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr} | 
 | \hrule} | 
 | @end tex | 
 | @iftex | 
 | { | 
 | @obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt | 
 | @dag@quad Prefix operators. | 
 | @ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}. | 
 | } | 
 | @end iftex | 
 | @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL | 
 |  | 
 | @node Evaluation | 
 | @subsection Evaluation | 
 | @cindex lazy evaluation | 
 | @cindex expression evaluation order | 
 | The linker evaluates expressions lazily.  It only computes the value of | 
 | an expression when absolutely necessary. | 
 |  | 
 | The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start | 
 | address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory | 
 | regions, in order to do any linking at all.  These values are computed | 
 | as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script. | 
 |  | 
 | However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed | 
 | until after storage allocation.  Such values are evaluated later, when | 
 | other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available | 
 | for use in the symbol assignment expression. | 
 |  | 
 | The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so | 
 | assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after | 
 | allocation. | 
 |  | 
 | Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter | 
 | @samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation. | 
 |  | 
 | If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not | 
 | available, then an error results.  For example, a script like the | 
 | following | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     .text 9+this_isnt_constant : | 
 |       @{ *(.text) @} | 
 |   @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial | 
 | address}. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Expression Section | 
 | @subsection The Section of an Expression | 
 | @cindex expression sections | 
 | @cindex absolute expressions | 
 | @cindex relative expressions | 
 | @cindex absolute and relocatable symbols | 
 | @cindex relocatable and absolute symbols | 
 | @cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute | 
 | Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute.  A section | 
 | relative symbol is relocatable.  If you request relocatable output | 
 | using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the | 
 | value of a section relative symbol.  On the other hand, an absolute | 
 | symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link | 
 | operations. | 
 |  | 
 | Some terms in linker expressions are addresses.  This is true of | 
 | section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an | 
 | address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and | 
 | @code{SEGMENT_START}.  Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin | 
 | functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}. | 
 | One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} | 
 | (@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated | 
 | differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older | 
 | versions of @code{ld}.  Expressions appearing outside an output | 
 | section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses. | 
 | Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat | 
 | absolute symbols as numbers.  If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is | 
 | given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers | 
 | everywhere. | 
 |  | 
 | In the following simple example, | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     . = 0x100; | 
 |     __executable_start = 0x100; | 
 |     .data : | 
 |     @{ | 
 |       . = 0x10; | 
 |       __data_start = 0x10; | 
 |       *(.data) | 
 |     @} | 
 |     @dots{} | 
 |   @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute | 
 | address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and | 
 | @code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data} | 
 | section in the second two assignments. | 
 |  | 
 | For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute | 
 | addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize @bullet | 
 | @item | 
 | Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary | 
 | operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one | 
 | absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s). | 
 | @item | 
 | Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two | 
 | relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address | 
 | and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es). | 
 | @item | 
 | Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not | 
 | in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute | 
 | address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address | 
 | before applying the operator. | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | The result section of each sub-expression is as follows: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize @bullet | 
 | @item | 
 | An operation involving only numbers results in a number. | 
 | @item | 
 | The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number. | 
 | @item | 
 | The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two | 
 | relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses | 
 | (after above conversions) is also a number when | 
 | @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition | 
 | but an absolute address otherwise. | 
 | @item | 
 | The result of other operations on relative addresses or one | 
 | relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same | 
 | section as the relative operand(s). | 
 | @item | 
 | The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above | 
 | conversions) is an absolute address. | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression | 
 | to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative.  For example, to | 
 | create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output | 
 | section @samp{.data}: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @} | 
 |   @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the | 
 | @samp{.data} section. | 
 |  | 
 | Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this | 
 | particular builtin function returns an absolute address. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Builtin Functions | 
 | @subsection Builtin Functions | 
 | @cindex functions in expressions | 
 | The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for | 
 | use in linker script expressions. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @code | 
 | @item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp}) | 
 | @kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp}) | 
 | @cindex expression, absolute | 
 | Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value | 
 | of the expression @var{exp}.  Primarily useful to assign an absolute | 
 | value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are | 
 | normally section relative.  @xref{Expression Section}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item ADDR(@var{section}) | 
 | @kindex ADDR(@var{section}) | 
 | @cindex section address in expression | 
 | Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}.  Your | 
 | script must previously have defined the location of that section.  In | 
 | the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and | 
 | @code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that | 
 | @code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while | 
 | the other two will be absolute: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | SECTIONS @{ @dots{} | 
 |   .output1 : | 
 |     @{ | 
 |     start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.); | 
 |     @dots{} | 
 |     @} | 
 |   .output : | 
 |     @{ | 
 |     symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1); | 
 |     symbol_2 = start_of_output_1; | 
 |     @} | 
 | @dots{} @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @item ALIGN(@var{align}) | 
 | @itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align}) | 
 | @kindex ALIGN(@var{align}) | 
 | @kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align}) | 
 | @cindex round up location counter | 
 | @cindex align location counter | 
 | @cindex round up expression | 
 | @cindex align expression | 
 | Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned | 
 | to the next @var{align} boundary.  The single operand @code{ALIGN} | 
 | doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does | 
 | arithmetic on it.  The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary | 
 | expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is | 
 | equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}). | 
 |  | 
 | Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the | 
 | next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a | 
 | variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the | 
 | input sections: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | SECTIONS @{ @dots{} | 
 |   .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{ | 
 |     *(.data) | 
 |     variable = ALIGN(0x8000); | 
 |   @} | 
 | @dots{} @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of | 
 | a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of | 
 | a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}).  The second use | 
 | of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol. | 
 |  | 
 | The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item ALIGNOF(@var{section}) | 
 | @kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section}) | 
 | @cindex section alignment | 
 | Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has | 
 | been allocated.  If the section has not been allocated when this is | 
 | evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example, | 
 | the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first | 
 | value in that section. | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | SECTIONS@{ @dots{} | 
 |   .output @{ | 
 |     LONG (ALIGNOF (.output)) | 
 |     @dots{} | 
 |     @} | 
 | @dots{} @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @item BLOCK(@var{exp}) | 
 | @kindex BLOCK(@var{exp}) | 
 | This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker | 
 | scripts.  It is most often seen when setting the address of an output | 
 | section. | 
 |  | 
 | @item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize}) | 
 | @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize}) | 
 | This is equivalent to either | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1))) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | or | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) | 
 |  + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize}))) | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 | @noindent | 
 | depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages | 
 | for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and | 
 | @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not. | 
 | If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime | 
 | memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted | 
 | bytes in the on-disk file. | 
 |  | 
 | This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in | 
 | any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script. | 
 | @var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should | 
 | be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still | 
 | running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}.  Note however | 
 | that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system | 
 | page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}. | 
 |  | 
 | @noindent | 
 | Example: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000); | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp}) | 
 | @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp}) | 
 | This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} | 
 | evaluation purposes. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.); | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp}) | 
 | @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp}) | 
 | This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when | 
 | @samp{-z relro} option is used. | 
 | When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END} | 
 | does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that | 
 | @var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize} | 
 | argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}.  If present in the linker | 
 | script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and | 
 | @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}.  Evaluates to the second argument plus any | 
 | padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to | 
 | section alignment. | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 |   . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .); | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @item DEFINED(@var{symbol}) | 
 | @kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol}) | 
 | @cindex symbol defaults | 
 | Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is | 
 | defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise | 
 | return 0.  You can use this function to provide | 
 | default values for symbols.  For example, the following script fragment | 
 | shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in | 
 | the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already | 
 | existed, its value is preserved: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | SECTIONS @{ @dots{} | 
 |   .text : @{ | 
 |     begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ; | 
 |     @dots{} | 
 |   @} | 
 |   @dots{} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @item LENGTH(@var{memory}) | 
 | @kindex LENGTH(@var{memory}) | 
 | Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item LOADADDR(@var{section}) | 
 | @kindex LOADADDR(@var{section}) | 
 | @cindex section load address in expression | 
 | Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}.  (@pxref{Output | 
 | Section LMA}). | 
 |  | 
 | @item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp}) | 
 | @kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp}) | 
 | Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity. | 
 | @code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex MAX | 
 | @item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2}) | 
 | Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex MIN | 
 | @item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2}) | 
 | Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item NEXT(@var{exp}) | 
 | @kindex NEXT(@var{exp}) | 
 | @cindex unallocated address, next | 
 | Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}. | 
 | This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you | 
 | use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the | 
 | output file, the two functions are equivalent. | 
 |  | 
 | @item ORIGIN(@var{memory}) | 
 | @kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory}) | 
 | Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default}) | 
 | @kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default}) | 
 | Return the base address of the named @var{segment}.  If an explicit | 
 | value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line | 
 | @samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value | 
 | will be @var{default}.  At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option | 
 | can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and | 
 | ``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment | 
 | name. | 
 |  | 
 | @item SIZEOF(@var{section}) | 
 | @kindex SIZEOF(@var{section}) | 
 | @cindex section size | 
 | Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has | 
 | been allocated.  If the section has not been allocated when this is | 
 | evaluated, the linker will report an error.  In the following example, | 
 | @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values: | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | @group | 
 | SECTIONS@{ @dots{} | 
 |   .output @{ | 
 |     .start = . ; | 
 |     @dots{} | 
 |     .end = . ; | 
 |     @} | 
 |   symbol_1 = .end - .start ; | 
 |   symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output); | 
 | @dots{} @} | 
 | @end group | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @item SIZEOF_HEADERS | 
 | @kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS | 
 | @cindex header size | 
 | Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers.  This is | 
 | information which appears at the start of the output file.  You can use | 
 | this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you | 
 | choose, to facilitate paging. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex not enough room for program headers | 
 | @cindex program headers, not enough room | 
 | When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the | 
 | @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the | 
 | number of program headers before it has determined all the section | 
 | addresses and sizes.  If the linker later discovers that it needs | 
 | additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough | 
 | room for program headers}.  To avoid this error, you must avoid using | 
 | the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker | 
 | script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or | 
 | you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS} | 
 | command (@pxref{PHDRS}). | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @node Implicit Linker Scripts | 
 | @section Implicit Linker Scripts | 
 | @cindex implicit linker scripts | 
 | If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as | 
 | an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a | 
 | linker script.  If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the | 
 | linker will report an error. | 
 |  | 
 | An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script. | 
 |  | 
 | Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol | 
 | assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION} | 
 | commands. | 
 |  | 
 | Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read | 
 | at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was | 
 | read.  This can affect archive searching. | 
 |  | 
 | @node Plugins | 
 | @chapter Linker Plugins | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex plugins | 
 | @cindex linker plugins | 
 | The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior. | 
 | For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers | 
 | support is implemented with a linker plugin. | 
 |  | 
 | Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may | 
 | be added here later. | 
 |  | 
 | Plugins are enabled via the use of the @option{-plugin @var{name}} | 
 | command line option. @xref{Options}. | 
 |  | 
 | @menu | 
 | * libdep Plugin::	Static Library Dependencies Plugin | 
 | @end menu | 
 |  | 
 | @node libdep Plugin | 
 | @section Static Library Dependencies Plugin | 
 | @cindex static library dependencies | 
 | Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting | 
 | just of a collection of relocatable object files.  Later they evolved to | 
 | optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects | 
 | within a library.  There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries | 
 | rose to ascendance. | 
 |  | 
 | One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting | 
 | multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their | 
 | dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic | 
 | library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly | 
 | referenced as well.  But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a | 
 | link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static | 
 | libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to | 
 | explicitly list the dependencies of the static library. | 
 |  | 
 | The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option | 
 | to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep} | 
 | plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time.  The | 
 | dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l} | 
 | and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker | 
 | command line.  As such, the information can be written with any text | 
 | utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not | 
 | being used to create the archive.  The information is stored in an | 
 | archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}. | 
 |  | 
 | For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another | 
 | library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib}, | 
 | the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | -L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset GENERIC | 
 | @node Machine Dependent | 
 | @chapter Machine Dependent Features | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex machine dependencies | 
 | @command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following | 
 | sections describe them.  Machines where @command{ld} has no additional | 
 | functionality are not listed. | 
 |  | 
 | @menu | 
 | @ifset H8300 | 
 | * H8/300::                      @command{ld} and the H8/300 | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset M68HC11 | 
 | * M68HC11/68HC12::		@code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset ARM | 
 | * ARM::				@command{ld} and the ARM family | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset HPPA | 
 | * HPPA ELF32::                  @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset M68K | 
 | * M68K::			@command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset MIPS | 
 | * MIPS::			@command{ld} and the MIPS family | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset MMIX | 
 | * MMIX::			@command{ld} and MMIX | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset MSP430 | 
 | * MSP430::			@command{ld} and MSP430 | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset NDS32 | 
 | * NDS32::			@command{ld} and NDS32 | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset NIOSII | 
 | * Nios II::			@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset POWERPC | 
 | * PowerPC ELF32::		@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset POWERPC64 | 
 | * PowerPC64 ELF64::		@command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset S/390 | 
 | * S/390 ELF::			@command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset SPU | 
 | * SPU ELF::			@command{ld} and SPU ELF Support | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset TICOFF | 
 | * TI COFF::                     @command{ld} and TI COFF | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset WIN32 | 
 | * WIN32::                       @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw) | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @ifset XTENSA | 
 | * Xtensa::                      @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @end menu | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset H8300 | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node H8/300 | 
 | @section @command{ld} and the H8/300 | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex H8/300 support | 
 | For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when | 
 | you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @emph | 
 | @cindex relaxing on H8/300 | 
 | @item relaxing address modes | 
 | @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose | 
 | targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit | 
 | program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions, | 
 | respectively. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex synthesizing on H8/300 | 
 | @item synthesizing instructions | 
 | @c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S | 
 | @command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the | 
 | sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top | 
 | page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form. | 
 | (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into | 
 | @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the | 
 | top page of memory). | 
 |  | 
 | @command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register | 
 | indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small | 
 | displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use | 
 | the 16-bit displacement form.  (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b | 
 | @code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx} | 
 | whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer | 
 | range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld). | 
 |  | 
 | @item bit manipulation instructions | 
 | @command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr, | 
 | biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor} | 
 | which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top | 
 | page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form. | 
 | (That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into | 
 | @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in | 
 | the top page of memory). | 
 |  | 
 | @item system control instructions | 
 | @command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the | 
 | 32 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and | 
 | changes them to use 16 bit address form. | 
 | (That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into | 
 | @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in | 
 | the top page of memory). | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @ifset Renesas | 
 | @c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned | 
 | @c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please. | 
 | @node Renesas | 
 | @chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips | 
 |  | 
 | @command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H, | 
 | H8/500, and SH chips.  No special features, commands, or command-line | 
 | options are required for these chips. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset ARM | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset M68HC11 | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node M68HC11/68HC12 | 
 | @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support | 
 |  | 
 | @subsection Linker Relaxation | 
 |  | 
 | For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global | 
 | optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @emph | 
 | @cindex relaxing on M68HC11 | 
 | @item relaxing address modes | 
 | @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose | 
 | targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit | 
 | program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions, | 
 | respectively. | 
 |  | 
 | @command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and | 
 | transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in | 
 | page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff). | 
 |  | 
 | @item relaxing gcc instruction group | 
 | When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group | 
 | of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct | 
 | addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or | 
 | @code{bset} instructions. | 
 |  | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @subsection Trampoline Generation | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11 | 
 | @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12 | 
 | For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to | 
 | call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker | 
 | will also change the relocation to some far function to use the | 
 | trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the | 
 | case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact | 
 | point to the function trampoline. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @node ARM | 
 | @section @command{ld} and the ARM family | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex ARM interworking support | 
 | @kindex --support-old-code | 
 | For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls | 
 | between ARM and Thumb code.  These stubs only work with code that has | 
 | been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command | 
 | line option.  If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or | 
 | libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork | 
 | option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be | 
 | given to the linker.  This will make it generate larger stub functions | 
 | which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code.  Note, however, | 
 | the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to | 
 | non-interworking aware Thumb code. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex thumb entry point | 
 | @cindex entry point, thumb | 
 | @kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry} | 
 | The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic | 
 | @samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address. | 
 | But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be | 
 | branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start | 
 | executing in Thumb mode straight away. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PE import table prefixing | 
 | @kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables | 
 | The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that | 
 | the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero | 
 | element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate | 
 | import tables. By default this option is turned off. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex BE8 | 
 | @kindex --be8 | 
 | The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format | 
 | executables.  This option is only valid when linking big-endian | 
 | objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB} | 
 | option.  The resulting image will contain big-endian data and | 
 | little-endian code. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex TARGET1 | 
 | @kindex --target1-rel | 
 | @kindex --target1-abs | 
 | The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the | 
 | @samp{.init_array} section.  It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32} | 
 | or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target.  The @samp{--target1-rel} | 
 | and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex TARGET2 | 
 | @kindex --target2=@var{type} | 
 | The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the | 
 | @samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation.  Valid values for @samp{type}, their | 
 | meanings, and target defaults are as follows: | 
 | @table @samp | 
 | @item rel | 
 | @samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi) | 
 | @item abs | 
 | @samp{R_ARM_ABS32} | 
 | @item got-rel | 
 | @samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd) | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex FIX_V4BX | 
 | @kindex --fix-v4bx | 
 | The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF | 
 | specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be | 
 | interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but | 
 | also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects. | 
 |  | 
 | In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the | 
 | linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as | 
 | @code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction. | 
 |  | 
 | In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} | 
 | relocations are ignored. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING | 
 | @kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking | 
 | Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} | 
 | relocations with a branch to the following veneer: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | TST rM, #1 | 
 | MOVEQ PC, rM | 
 | BX Rn | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores | 
 | and are still interworking safe.  Note that the above veneer clobbers the | 
 | condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex USE_BLX | 
 | @kindex --use-blx | 
 | The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb | 
 | BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various | 
 | situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb | 
 | code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before | 
 | each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX | 
 | @kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix | 
 | The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a | 
 | bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows | 
 | instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code) | 
 | to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before | 
 | the support code can read the intended values. | 
 |  | 
 | The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one | 
 | intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register | 
 | and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two | 
 | intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects | 
 | full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if | 
 | you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details. | 
 |  | 
 | If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can | 
 | enable this workaround by specifying the linker option | 
 | @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar | 
 | mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using | 
 | vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is | 
 | @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}. | 
 |  | 
 | If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for | 
 | potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each | 
 | such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the | 
 | first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent | 
 | instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to | 
 | the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer | 
 | are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround | 
 | @kindex --fix-arm1176 | 
 | @kindex --no-fix-arm1176 | 
 | The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum | 
 | in certain ARM1176 processors.  The workaround is enabled by default if you | 
 | are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier.  It can be disabled | 
 | unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}. | 
 |  | 
 | Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S | 
 | Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at: | 
 | http://infocenter.arm.com/. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround | 
 | @kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360 | 
 |  | 
 | The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time | 
 | workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of | 
 | the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx).  When accessing | 
 | off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more, | 
 | the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort.  These are only | 
 | core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access: | 
 | integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM, | 
 | VPOP.  Stores are not affected. | 
 |  | 
 | The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the | 
 | necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words. | 
 |  | 
 | The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use | 
 | @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}.  If you know you are using buggy | 
 | STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the | 
 | linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent | 
 | @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}. | 
 |  | 
 | If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for | 
 | potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each | 
 | such sequence which may trigger the erratum.  The veneer consists in a | 
 | replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a | 
 | branch back to the subsequent instruction.  The original instruction is | 
 | then replaced with a branch to the veneer. | 
 |  | 
 | The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for | 
 | the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC. | 
 |  | 
 | The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when | 
 | they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed | 
 | there.  In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement | 
 | occurs. | 
 |  | 
 | The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a | 
 | PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too | 
 | large.  In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code | 
 | cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement | 
 | occurs. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING | 
 | @kindex --no-enum-size-warning | 
 | The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from | 
 | warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI | 
 | enumeration size attributes.  For example, with this switch enabled, | 
 | linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another | 
 | using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will | 
 | not be diagnosed. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING | 
 | @kindex --no-wchar-size-warning | 
 | The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from | 
 | warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI | 
 | @code{wchar_t} size attributes.  For example, with this switch enabled, | 
 | linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another | 
 | using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PIC_VENEER | 
 | @kindex --pic-veneer | 
 | The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for | 
 | ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary | 
 | is not PIC.  This avoids problems on uClinux targets where | 
 | @samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE | 
 | @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N} | 
 | The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of | 
 | code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to | 
 | perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away.  The | 
 | placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is | 
 | controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}. | 
 | The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for | 
 | duplicate stubs, increasing the code size.  The linker will try to | 
 | group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of | 
 | code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and | 
 | where they should be placed. | 
 |  | 
 | The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the | 
 | @option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are | 
 | placed.  If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first | 
 | branch that needs them.  If it is positive then the stubs can be | 
 | placed either before or after the branches that need them.  If the | 
 | value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose | 
 | exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics. | 
 | A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the | 
 | linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes | 
 | from the input sections. | 
 |  | 
 | The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is | 
 | @samp{N = +1}. | 
 |  | 
 | Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target | 
 | only, because it relies on object files properties not present | 
 | otherwise. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround | 
 | @kindex --fix-cortex-a8 | 
 | @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8 | 
 | The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors.  The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile.  It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}. | 
 |  | 
 | The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code.  Please contact ARM for further details. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround | 
 | @kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769 | 
 | @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769 | 
 | The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors.  The workaround is disabled by default.  It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}. | 
 |  | 
 | Please contact ARM for further details. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --merge-exidx-entries | 
 | @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries | 
 | @cindex Merging exidx entries | 
 | The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --long-plt | 
 | @cindex 32-bit PLT entries | 
 | The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries | 
 | which support up to 4Gb of code.  The default is to use 12 byte PLT | 
 | entries which only support 512Mb of code. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs | 
 | @cindex AArch64 rela addend | 
 | The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply | 
 | link-time values for dynamic relocations. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex Placement of SG veneers | 
 | All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}. | 
 | Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option | 
 | @samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these | 
 | veneers in memory. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --cmse-implib | 
 | @cindex Secure gateway import library | 
 | The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries | 
 | specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are | 
 | secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure | 
 | executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --in-implib=@var{file} | 
 | @cindex Input import library | 
 | The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols | 
 | must keep the same address in the executable being produced.  A warning is | 
 | given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced | 
 | in the executable that should be listed in its import library.  Otherwise, if | 
 | @samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import | 
 | library.  A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import | 
 | library have disappeared from the executable.  This option is only effective | 
 | for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is | 
 | specified. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset HPPA | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node HPPA ELF32 | 
 | @section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support | 
 | @cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs | 
 | @kindex --multi-subspace | 
 | When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate | 
 | import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application. | 
 | The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export | 
 | stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with | 
 | multiple sub-spaces. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex HPPA stub grouping | 
 | @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N} | 
 | Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in | 
 | stub sections located between groups of input sections. | 
 | @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input | 
 | sections handled by one stub section.  Since branch offsets are signed, | 
 | a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before | 
 | the stub section, and one group after it.  However, when using | 
 | conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch | 
 | prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections. | 
 | A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that | 
 | branches to stubs always use a negative offset.  Two special values of | 
 | @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}.  These both instruct | 
 | @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types | 
 | detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other | 
 | positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively. | 
 |  | 
 | Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections.  A | 
 | single input section larger than the group size specified will of course | 
 | create a larger group (of one section).  If input sections are too | 
 | large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset M68K | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node M68K | 
 | @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation | 
 | @kindex --got=@var{type} | 
 | The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme. | 
 | The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and | 
 | @samp{target}.  When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses | 
 | the default GOT generation scheme for the current target. | 
 | @samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with | 
 | entries only at non-negative offsets. | 
 | @samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with | 
 | entries at both negative and positive offsets.  Not all environments | 
 | support such GOTs. | 
 | @samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the | 
 | output file.  All GOT references from a single input object | 
 | file access the same GOT, but references from different input object | 
 | files might access different GOTs.  Not all environments support such GOTs. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset MIPS | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node MIPS | 
 | @section @command{ld} and the MIPS family | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection | 
 | @kindex --insn32 | 
 | @kindex --no-insn32 | 
 | The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of | 
 | microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that | 
 | in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation.  If @samp{--insn32} is | 
 | used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings.  By default | 
 | or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used, | 
 | including 16-bit ones where possible. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex MIPS branch relocation check control | 
 | @kindex --ignore-branch-isa | 
 | @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa | 
 | The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options | 
 | control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions.  If | 
 | @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch | 
 | relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation | 
 | calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet | 
 | relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX} | 
 | instructions as the associated relocation is calculated.  By default | 
 | or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing | 
 | the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset MMIX | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node MMIX | 
 | @section @code{ld} and MMIX | 
 | For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or | 
 | @code{mmo} object files when linking.  The simulator @code{mmix} | 
 | understands the @code{mmo} format.  The binutils @code{objcopy} utility | 
 | can translate between the two formats. | 
 |  | 
 | There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section. | 
 | Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global | 
 | registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols, | 
 | equal to registers.  In a final link, the start address of the | 
 | @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated | 
 | global register multiplied by 8.  Register @code{$255} is not included in | 
 | this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the | 
 | symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files. | 
 |  | 
 | Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example | 
 | @code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special. | 
 | The default linker script uses these to set the default start address | 
 | of a section. | 
 |  | 
 | Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section, | 
 | are left out from an mmo file. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset MSP430 | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node  MSP430 | 
 | @section @code{ld} and MSP430 | 
 | For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture.  The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]} | 
 | will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type.  (To get a list of known MPUs | 
 | just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker). | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex MSP430 extra sections | 
 | The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific: | 
 |  | 
 | @table @code | 
 | @item @samp{.vectors} | 
 | Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @samp{.bootloader} | 
 | Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable).  Any code | 
 | in this section will be uploaded to the MPU. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @samp{.infomem} | 
 | Defines an information memory section (if applicable).  Any code in | 
 | this section will be uploaded to the MPU. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @samp{.infomemnobits} | 
 | This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code | 
 | in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @samp{.noinit} | 
 | Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section. | 
 |  | 
 | The last two sections are used by gcc. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @table @option | 
 | @cindex MSP430 Options | 
 | @kindex --code-region | 
 | @item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none] | 
 | This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The | 
 | argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker | 
 | using this option. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --data-region | 
 | @item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none] | 
 | This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to | 
 | [either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC | 
 | for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --disable-sec-transformation | 
 | @item --disable-sec-transformation | 
 | Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region} | 
 | and @code{--data-region} options. | 
 | This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC | 
 | wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but | 
 | not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset NDS32 | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node NDS32 | 
 | @section @code{ld} and NDS32 | 
 | @kindex relaxing on NDS32 | 
 | For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior.  The linker | 
 | relaxes objects according to these options. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @code | 
 | @item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp} | 
 | Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE} | 
 | Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @samp{--m[no-]ex9} | 
 | Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE} | 
 | Export the EX9 table after linking. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE} | 
 | Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @samp{--mupdate-ex9} | 
 | Update the existing EX9 table. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM} | 
 | Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware} | 
 | Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @samp{--m[no-]ifc} | 
 | Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization. | 
 |  | 
 | @item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware} | 
 | Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset NIOSII | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node Nios II | 
 | @section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II | 
 | @cindex Nios II call relaxation | 
 | @kindex --relax on Nios II | 
 |  | 
 | Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to | 
 | transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment, | 
 | which may result in @command{ld} giving | 
 | @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs. | 
 | The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of | 
 | trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls | 
 | outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range.  These | 
 | trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves | 
 | be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are | 
 | larger than 256MB. | 
 |  | 
 | The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r} | 
 | is also specified.  You can disable trampoline generation by using the | 
 | @option{--no-relax} linker option.  You can also disable this optimization | 
 | locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language | 
 | source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at} | 
 | register as a temporary. | 
 |  | 
 | Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler | 
 | relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all} | 
 | option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset POWERPC | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node PowerPC ELF32 | 
 | @section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support | 
 | @cindex PowerPC long branches | 
 | @kindex --relax on PowerPC | 
 | Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit | 
 | displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving | 
 | @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs. | 
 | @samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access | 
 | the entire 32-bit address space.  These trampolines are inserted at | 
 | section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input | 
 | section exceeds 33M in size.  You may combine @samp{-r} and | 
 | @samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link.  In that case | 
 | both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also | 
 | considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC ELF32 options | 
 | @table @option | 
 | @cindex PowerPC PLT | 
 | @kindex --bss-plt | 
 | @item --bss-plt | 
 | Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that | 
 | generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has | 
 | the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be | 
 | writable and no writable section ever being executable.  PowerPC | 
 | @command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the | 
 | PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were | 
 | compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}.  @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old | 
 | BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance. | 
 |  | 
 | @kindex --secure-plt | 
 | @item --secure-plt | 
 | @command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new | 
 | @samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically | 
 | when linking non-PIC code.  This option requests the new PLT and GOT | 
 | layout.  A warning will be given if some object file requires the old | 
 | style BSS PLT. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC GOT | 
 | @kindex --sdata-got | 
 | @item --sdata-got | 
 | The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other | 
 | sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement.  The location of | 
 | @code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized | 
 | section while the old PLT is uninitialized.  The reason for the | 
 | @code{.got} change is more subtle:  The new placement allows | 
 | @code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with | 
 | @samp{-z relro -z now}.  However, this placement means that | 
 | @code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the | 
 | PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT | 
 | pointer.  @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement.  PowerPC | 
 | GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is | 
 | really only useful for other compilers that may do so. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC stub symbols | 
 | @kindex --emit-stub-syms | 
 | @item --emit-stub-syms | 
 | This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local | 
 | symbol that encodes the stub type and destination. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC TLS optimization | 
 | @kindex --no-tls-optimize | 
 | @item --no-tls-optimize | 
 | PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code | 
 | sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage.  Use this option to | 
 | disable the optimization. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset POWERPC64 | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node PowerPC64 ELF64 | 
 | @section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options | 
 | @table @option | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping | 
 | @kindex --stub-group-size | 
 | @item --stub-group-size | 
 | Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs  and TOC adjusting stubs are placed | 
 | by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections. | 
 | @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input | 
 | sections handled by one stub section.  Since branch offsets are signed, | 
 | a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before | 
 | the stub section, and one group after it.  However, when using | 
 | conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch | 
 | prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections. | 
 | A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that | 
 | branches to stubs always use a negative offset.  Two special values of | 
 | @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}.  These both instruct | 
 | @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types | 
 | detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other | 
 | positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively. | 
 |  | 
 | Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections.  A | 
 | single input section larger than the group size specified will of course | 
 | create a larger group (of one section).  If input sections are too | 
 | large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols | 
 | @kindex --emit-stub-syms | 
 | @item --emit-stub-syms | 
 | This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local | 
 | symbol that encodes the stub type and destination. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols | 
 | @kindex --dotsyms | 
 | @kindex --no-dotsyms | 
 | @item --dotsyms | 
 | @itemx --no-dotsyms | 
 | These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns | 
 | in a version script.  Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a | 
 | function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a | 
 | code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}).  To | 
 | properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs | 
 | to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}.  The option | 
 | @samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required | 
 | dot-prefixed patterns.  Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this | 
 | feature. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions | 
 | @kindex --save-restore-funcs | 
 | @kindex --no-save-restore-funcs | 
 | @item --save-restore-funcs | 
 | @itemx --no-save-restore-funcs | 
 | These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically | 
 | provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by | 
 | @samp{-Os} code.  The default is to provide any such referenced | 
 | function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable | 
 | link. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization | 
 | @kindex --no-tls-optimize | 
 | @item --no-tls-optimize | 
 | PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code | 
 | sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage.  Use this option to | 
 | disable the optimization. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization | 
 | @kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize | 
 | @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize | 
 | @kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave | 
 | @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave | 
 | @item --tls-get-addr-optimize | 
 | @itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize | 
 | These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special | 
 | stub to call __tls_get_addr.  PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support | 
 | an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to | 
 | @code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special | 
 | stub without calling in to glibc.  By default the linker enables | 
 | generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of | 
 | __tls_get_addr_opt. | 
 | Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do | 
 | much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking | 
 | an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it | 
 | will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc. | 
 | @option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves | 
 | and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc.  Normally, | 
 | this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc. | 
 | Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt. | 
 | @option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the | 
 | register saves. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization | 
 | @kindex --no-opd-optimize | 
 | @item --no-opd-optimize | 
 | PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries | 
 | corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by | 
 | the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}. | 
 | Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing | 
 | @kindex --non-overlapping-opd | 
 | @item --non-overlapping-opd | 
 | Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed | 
 | @code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word, | 
 | the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next | 
 | entry.  This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization | 
 | @kindex --no-toc-optimize | 
 | @item --no-toc-optimize | 
 | PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section | 
 | entries.  Such entries are detected by examining relocations that | 
 | reference the TOC in code sections.  A reloc in a deleted code section | 
 | marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section | 
 | marks a TOC word as needed.  Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC | 
 | relocs are also examined.  TOC words marked as both needed and | 
 | unneeded will of course be kept.  TOC words without any referencing | 
 | reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or | 
 | discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word.  This works | 
 | reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly | 
 | code is used to insert TOC entries.  Use this option to disable the | 
 | optimization. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization | 
 | @kindex --no-inline-optimize | 
 | @item --no-inline-optimize | 
 | PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences | 
 | marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL}, | 
 | @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by | 
 | a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined | 
 | locally and can't be overridden by some other definition.  This option | 
 | disables that optimization. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC | 
 | @kindex --no-multi-toc | 
 | @item --no-multi-toc | 
 | If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or | 
 | @code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model | 
 | where TOC | 
 | entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2.  This limits the | 
 | total TOC size to 64K.  PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by | 
 | grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its | 
 | TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group | 
 | calls.  @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot | 
 | help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds | 
 | 64K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}. | 
 | Use this option to turn off this feature. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting | 
 | @kindex --no-toc-sort | 
 | @item --no-toc-sort | 
 | By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file | 
 | happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are | 
 | placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated | 
 | with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections | 
 | referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's | 
 | @code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options.  Doing this | 
 | results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC.  Use this option to turn | 
 | off this feature. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment | 
 | @kindex --plt-align | 
 | @kindex --no-plt-align | 
 | @item --plt-align | 
 | @itemx --no-plt-align | 
 | Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are | 
 | aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two | 
 | boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}.  A negative value may be | 
 | specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the | 
 | specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries | 
 | if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary).  By default | 
 | PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain | 
 | @kindex --plt-static-chain | 
 | @kindex --no-plt-static-chain | 
 | @item --plt-static-chain | 
 | @itemx --no-plt-static-chain | 
 | Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static | 
 | chain pointer (r11).  @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static | 
 | chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety | 
 | @kindex --plt-thread-safe | 
 | @kindex --no-plt-thread-safe | 
 | @item --plt-thread-safe | 
 | @itemx --no-plt-thread-safe | 
 | With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using | 
 | lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have | 
 | another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong | 
 | order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using | 
 | memory write barriers.  To avoid this we need some sort of read | 
 | barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1.  By default, @code{ld} | 
 | looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if | 
 | seen, adds the necessary barriers.  Use these options to change the | 
 | default behaviour. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization | 
 | @kindex --plt-localentry | 
 | @kindex --no-plt-localentry | 
 | @item --plt-localentry | 
 | @itemx --no-localentry | 
 | ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point, | 
 | ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2 | 
 | (the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return. | 
 | Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2 | 
 | or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small | 
 | functions.   The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction | 
 | in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol | 
 | interposition failures.  Also, minor changes in a shared library, | 
 | including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0 | 
 | to become localentry:8.  This will result in a dynamic loader | 
 | complaint and failure to run.  The option is experimental, use with | 
 | care.  @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs | 
 | @kindex --power10-stubs | 
 | @kindex --no-power10-stubs | 
 | @item --power10-stubs | 
 | @itemx --no-power10-stubs | 
 | When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing | 
 | relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates | 
 | linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions | 
 | for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known.  The | 
 | power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for | 
 | power10.  @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs} | 
 | allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions. | 
 | @option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default | 
 | auto mode. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset S/390 | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node S/390 ELF | 
 | @section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex S/390 ELF options | 
 | @table @option | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex S/390 | 
 | @kindex --s390-pgste | 
 | @item --s390-pgste | 
 | This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE} | 
 | segment.  The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for | 
 | binaries marked that way. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset SPU | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node SPU ELF | 
 | @section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex SPU ELF options | 
 | @table @option | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex SPU plugins | 
 | @kindex --plugin | 
 | @item --plugin | 
 | This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex SPU overlays | 
 | @kindex --no-overlays | 
 | @item --no-overlays | 
 | Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay | 
 | regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub. | 
 | @command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager.  This option | 
 | turns off all this special overlay handling. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex SPU overlay stub symbols | 
 | @kindex --emit-stub-syms | 
 | @item --emit-stub-syms | 
 | This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local | 
 | symbol that encodes the stub type and destination. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex SPU extra overlay stubs | 
 | @kindex --extra-overlay-stubs | 
 | @item --extra-overlay-stubs | 
 | This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all | 
 | function calls out of overlay regions.  Normally stubs are not added | 
 | on calls to non-overlay regions. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex SPU local store size | 
 | @kindex --local-store=lo:hi | 
 | @item --local-store=lo:hi | 
 | @command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in | 
 | the address range 0 to 256k.  This option may be used to change the | 
 | range.  Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex SPU | 
 | @kindex --stack-analysis | 
 | @item --stack-analysis | 
 | SPU local store space is limited.  Over-allocation of stack space | 
 | unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while | 
 | under-allocation results in runtime failures.  If given this option, | 
 | @command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage. | 
 | @command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to | 
 | determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues | 
 | for stack adjusting instructions.  A call-graph is created by looking | 
 | for relocations on branch instructions.  The graph is then searched | 
 | for the maximum stack usage path.  Note that this analysis does not | 
 | find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion | 
 | and other cycles in the call graph.  Stack usage may be | 
 | under-estimated if your code makes such calls.  Also, stack usage for | 
 | dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected.  If a link map | 
 | is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage | 
 | and calls will be given. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex SPU | 
 | @kindex --emit-stack-syms | 
 | @item --emit-stack-syms | 
 | This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result | 
 | in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function. | 
 | These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global | 
 | functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static | 
 | functions.  @code{<number>} is the section id in hex.  The value of | 
 | such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function. | 
 | The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding | 
 | @code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset TICOFF | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node TI COFF | 
 | @section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions | 
 | @cindex TI COFF versions | 
 | @kindex --format=@var{version} | 
 | The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various | 
 | TI COFF versions.  The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are | 
 | also supported.  The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order | 
 | format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output | 
 | header format depends on the default specified by the specific target. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset WIN32 | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node WIN32 | 
 | @section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw) | 
 |  | 
 | This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues. | 
 | See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the | 
 | command-line options mentioned here. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @emph | 
 | @cindex import libraries | 
 | @item import libraries | 
 | The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import | 
 | libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's.  They are | 
 | regular static archives and are handled as any other static | 
 | archive.  The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific | 
 | support for creating such libraries provided with the | 
 | @samp{--out-implib} command-line option. | 
 |  | 
 | @item Resource only DLLs | 
 | It is possible to create a DLL that only contains resources, ie just a | 
 | @samp{.rsrc} section, but in order to do so a custom linker script | 
 | must be used.  This is because the built-in default linker scripts | 
 | will always create @samp{.text} and @samp{.idata} sections, even if | 
 | there is no input to go into them. | 
 |  | 
 | The script should look like this, although the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} | 
 | should be changed to match the desired format. | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | OUTPUT_FORMAT(pei-i386) | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |   . = SIZEOF_HEADERS; | 
 |   . = ALIGN(__section_alignment__); | 
 |   .rsrc __image_base__ + __section_alignment__ : ALIGN(4) | 
 |   @{ | 
 |     KEEP (*(.rsrc)) | 
 |     KEEP (*(.rsrc$*)) | 
 |   @} | 
 |   /DISCARD/ : @{ *(*) @} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | With this script saved to a file called, eg @file{rsrc.ld}, a command | 
 | line like this can be used to create the resource only DLL | 
 | @file{rsrc.dll} from an input file called @file{rsrc.o}: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | ld -dll --subsystem windows -e 0 -s rsrc.o -o rsrc.dll -T rsrc.ld | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @item   exporting DLL symbols | 
 | @cindex exporting DLL symbols | 
 | The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @emph | 
 | @item   using auto-export functionality | 
 | @cindex using auto-export functionality | 
 | By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality, | 
 | which is controlled by the following command-line options: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize | 
 | @item --export-all-symbols   [This is the default] | 
 | @item --exclude-symbols | 
 | @item --exclude-libs | 
 | @item --exclude-modules-for-implib | 
 | @item --version-script | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local | 
 | (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few | 
 | symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries.  As it will | 
 | often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include | 
 | private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line | 
 | options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for | 
 | exporting.  The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the | 
 | final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect. | 
 |  | 
 | If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the | 
 | command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled} | 
 | if either of the following are true: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize | 
 | @item A DEF file is used. | 
 | @item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute. | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | @item   using a DEF file | 
 | @cindex using a DEF file | 
 | Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file.  A DEF file is | 
 | an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be | 
 | exported when a dll is created.  Usually it is named @samp{<dll | 
 | name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's | 
 | command line.  The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}. | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the | 
 | @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used. | 
 |  | 
 | Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}: | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000 | 
 |  | 
 | EXPORTS | 
 | foo | 
 | bar | 
 | _bar = bar | 
 | another_foo = abc.dll.afoo | 
 | var1 DATA | 
 | doo = foo == foo2 | 
 | eoo DATA == var1 | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven | 
 | symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an | 
 | alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved | 
 | by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for | 
 | @code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol | 
 | @code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in | 
 | export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name | 
 | in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export | 
 | symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}. | 
 |  | 
 | The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal} | 
 | name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, | 
 | the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended. | 
 |  | 
 | When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a | 
 | library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of | 
 | @code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default | 
 | executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended. | 
 |  | 
 | With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional | 
 | specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a | 
 | non-default base address for the image. | 
 |  | 
 | If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor  @code{NAME <name>} is specified, | 
 | or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the | 
 | filename specified on the command line. | 
 |  | 
 | The complete specification of an export symbol is: | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | EXPORTS | 
 |   ( (  ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] ) | 
 |      | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>)) | 
 |   [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) * | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares | 
 | @samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares | 
 | @samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol | 
 | @samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}. | 
 | Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal | 
 | @samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used | 
 | string in import/export table for the symbol. | 
 |  | 
 | The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate: | 
 |  | 
 | @code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table.  It | 
 | will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified | 
 | by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the | 
 | linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import | 
 | library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified. | 
 |  | 
 | @code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function. | 
 | The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as | 
 | the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as | 
 | @code{*_imp__foo}). | 
 |  | 
 | @code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as | 
 | well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the | 
 | read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the | 
 | variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add | 
 | the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the | 
 | extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the | 
 | application will behave unexpectedly. | 
 |  | 
 | @code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put | 
 | it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The | 
 | symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress} | 
 | API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to | 
 | the DLL without an import library. | 
 |  | 
 | See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of | 
 | other DEF file statements | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex creating a DEF file | 
 | While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file | 
 | with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option. | 
 |  | 
 | @item   Using decorations | 
 | @cindex Using decorations | 
 | Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code | 
 | itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is | 
 | declared as: | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable | 
 | __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args) | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | All such symbols will be exported from the DLL.  If, however, | 
 | any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in | 
 | this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless | 
 | the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used. | 
 |  | 
 | Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not} | 
 | decorate them with dllexport.  Instead, they should use dllimport, | 
 | instead: | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable | 
 | __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args) | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | This complicates the structure of library header files, because | 
 | when included by the library itself the header must declare the | 
 | variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client | 
 | code the header must declare them as dllimport.  There are a number | 
 | of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can | 
 | omit the __declspec() declaration completely.  See | 
 | @samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more | 
 | information. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex automatic data imports | 
 | @item automatic data imports | 
 | The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only | 
 | by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the | 
 | compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this | 
 | issue.  This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x | 
 | code to these platforms, especially for large | 
 | c++ libraries and applications.  The auto-import feature, which was | 
 | initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the | 
 | decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x | 
 | platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import} | 
 | command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw. | 
 | The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to | 
 | suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects | 
 | trigger the feature's use. | 
 |  | 
 | auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without | 
 | additional assistance.  Sometimes, you will see this message | 
 |  | 
 | "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the | 
 | documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details." | 
 |  | 
 | The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error | 
 | occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty. | 
 | One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described | 
 | below. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex runtime pseudo-relocation | 
 | For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes), | 
 | object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an | 
 | offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular | 
 | field or public member, for instance.  Unfortunately, the runtime loader used | 
 | in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime | 
 | without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations. | 
 | The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these | 
 | references. | 
 |  | 
 | The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to | 
 | be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references | 
 | themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the | 
 | runtime environment.  Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and | 
 | compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not.  However, the | 
 | support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will | 
 | run without error on an older system. | 
 |  | 
 | @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly | 
 | enabled as needed. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex direct linking to a dll | 
 | @item direct linking to a dll | 
 | The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking, | 
 | including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import | 
 | libraries.  This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the | 
 | traditional import library method, especially when linking large | 
 | libraries or applications.  When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each | 
 | function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even | 
 | though a single bfd could contain many exports.  The overhead involved in | 
 | storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the | 
 | tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly | 
 | large or complex libraries when using import libs. | 
 |  | 
 | Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than | 
 | @samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number | 
 | of names to match each library.  All that is needed from the developer's | 
 | perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to | 
 | select the dll instead of an import library. | 
 |  | 
 |  | 
 | For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt | 
 | to find, in the first directory of its search path, | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | libxxx.dll.a | 
 | xxx.dll.a | 
 | libxxx.a | 
 | xxx.lib | 
 | libxxx.lib | 
 | cygxxx.dll (*) | 
 | libxxx.dll | 
 | xxx.dll | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | before moving on to the next directory in the search path. | 
 |  | 
 | (*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll}, | 
 | where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option | 
 | @samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec | 
 | file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for | 
 | @samp{cygxxx.dll}. | 
 |  | 
 | Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other | 
 | @samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature.  It | 
 | was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the | 
 | various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll | 
 | could coexist on the same machine. | 
 |  | 
 | The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for | 
 | applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import | 
 | libraries (using cygwin nomenclature): | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | bin/ | 
 | 	cygxxx.dll | 
 | lib/ | 
 | 	libxxx.dll.a   (in case of dll's) | 
 | 	libxxx.a       (in case of static archive) | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be | 
 | done two ways: | 
 |  | 
 | 1. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line | 
 | @example | 
 | gcc -Wl,-verbose  -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names | 
 | (@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies | 
 | @samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version.  Import libs are generally | 
 | not versioned, and do not have this difficulty. | 
 |  | 
 | 2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib} | 
 | directory according to the above mentioned search pattern.  This | 
 | should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for | 
 | making the app/dll. | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a] | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | Then you can link without any make environment changes. | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | gcc -Wl,-verbose  -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is | 
 | perfectly legal | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | bin/ | 
 | 	cygxxx-5.dll | 
 | lib/ | 
 | 	libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work | 
 | even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when | 
 | @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used. | 
 |  | 
 | Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably | 
 | wonder why import libraries are used at all.  There are three reasons: | 
 |  | 
 | 1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not} | 
 | work with auto-imported data. | 
 |  | 
 | 2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the | 
 | import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection | 
 | symbols that point to the exports of a dll).  Again, the import lib | 
 | for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not | 
 | possible to do this without an import lib. | 
 |  | 
 | 3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib.  This is | 
 | critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API) | 
 | in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their | 
 | stdcall-decorated assembly names. | 
 |  | 
 | So, import libs are not going away.  But the ability to replace | 
 | true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of) | 
 | a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools | 
 | binutils makes available to the win32 developer.  Given the | 
 | massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage | 
 | requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers | 
 | will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible. | 
 |  | 
 | @item symbol aliasing | 
 | @table @emph | 
 | @item adding additional names | 
 | Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names. | 
 | A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be | 
 | exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file | 
 | when creating the dll.  This will affect also the optional created | 
 | import library.  Consider the following DEF file: | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000 | 
 |  | 
 | EXPORTS | 
 | foo | 
 | _foo = foo | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}. | 
 |  | 
 | Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the | 
 | source code using the "weak" attribute: | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | void foo () @{ /* Do something.  */; @} | 
 | void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo"))); | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak | 
 | symbols. | 
 |  | 
 | @item renaming symbols | 
 | Sometimes it is useful to rename exports.  For instance, the cygwin | 
 | kernel does this regularly.  A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as | 
 | @samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the | 
 | DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is | 
 | created).  In the following example: | 
 |  | 
 | @example | 
 | LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000 | 
 |  | 
 | EXPORTS | 
 | _foo = foo | 
 | @end example | 
 |  | 
 | The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to | 
 | @samp{_foo}. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior, | 
 | unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used. | 
 | If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list | 
 | @emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols | 
 | that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the | 
 | @samp{--export-all-symbols} option.  If you list only the | 
 | renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols} | 
 | to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and} | 
 | the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported. | 
 | In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them, | 
 | which is probably not what you wanted. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex weak externals | 
 | @item weak externals | 
 | The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called | 
 | weak externals.  When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not | 
 | defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol.  There | 
 | are three variants of weak externals: | 
 | @itemize | 
 | @item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically | 
 | called lazy externals. | 
 | @item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries. | 
 | This form is not presently implemented. | 
 | @item No search; the symbol is an alias.  This form is not presently | 
 | implemented. | 
 | @end itemize | 
 | As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol | 
 | are supported.  If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol | 
 | uses a default value. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex aligned common symbols | 
 | @item aligned common symbols | 
 | As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the | 
 | desired alignment for a common symbol.  This information is conveyed from | 
 | the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands | 
 | carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized | 
 | by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols.  Native | 
 | tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension, | 
 | but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy | 
 | warnings about unknown linker directives. | 
 |  | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset XTENSA | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @raisesections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node Xtensa | 
 | @section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex Xtensa processors | 
 | The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret | 
 | @code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a | 
 | specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to | 
 | keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets.  For | 
 | example, with the command: | 
 |  | 
 | @smallexample | 
 | SECTIONS | 
 | @{ | 
 |   .text : @{ | 
 |     *(.literal .text) | 
 |   @} | 
 | @} | 
 | @end smallexample | 
 |  | 
 | @noindent | 
 | @command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal} | 
 | and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the | 
 | literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets.  A valid | 
 | interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial | 
 | group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of | 
 | files.  Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files | 
 | and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa | 
 | @cindex relaxing on Xtensa | 
 | Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and | 
 | provides two important link-time optimizations.  The first optimization | 
 | is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size.  A redundant | 
 | literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it | 
 | will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the | 
 | location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all | 
 | the @code{L32R} instructions.  The second optimization is to remove | 
 | unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of | 
 | @code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within | 
 | range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions. | 
 |  | 
 | For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized | 
 | to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}} | 
 | instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R} | 
 | instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R} | 
 | instruction if it is not used for anything else.  Removing the | 
 | @code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially | 
 | hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets. | 
 | By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by | 
 | switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent | 
 | density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R} | 
 | instruction that was removed.  If code size is more important than | 
 | performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the | 
 | linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in | 
 | a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness. | 
 |  | 
 | The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to | 
 | control the linker: | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex Xtensa options | 
 | @table @option | 
 | @item --size-opt | 
 | When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size | 
 | more than performance.  With this option, the linker will not insert | 
 | no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target | 
 | alignment.  There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to | 
 | preserve the correctness of the code. | 
 |  | 
 | @item --abi-windowed | 
 | @itemx --abi-call0 | 
 | Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code. | 
 | PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object | 
 | because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call | 
 | conventions. | 
 | Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section | 
 | of the first input object. | 
 | A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other | 
 | or the chosen output object ABI. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear GENERIC | 
 | @lowersections | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | @ifclear SingleFormat | 
 | @node BFD | 
 | @chapter BFD | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex back end | 
 | @cindex object file management | 
 | @cindex object formats available | 
 | @kindex objdump -i | 
 | The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries. | 
 | These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on | 
 | object files whatever the object file format.  A different object file | 
 | format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding | 
 | it to the library.  To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and | 
 | associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the | 
 | object file formats available.  You can use @code{objdump -i} | 
 | (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to | 
 | list all the formats available for your configuration. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex BFD requirements | 
 | @cindex requirements for BFD | 
 | As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between | 
 | several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing | 
 | BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between | 
 | formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not | 
 | been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since | 
 | BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care | 
 | may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed. | 
 |  | 
 | One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in | 
 | mind is the potential for information loss.  There are two places where | 
 | useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during | 
 | conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}. | 
 |  | 
 | @menu | 
 | * BFD outline::                 How it works: an outline of BFD | 
 | @end menu | 
 |  | 
 | @node BFD outline | 
 | @section How It Works: An Outline of BFD | 
 | @cindex opening object files | 
 | @include bfdsumm.texi | 
 | @end ifclear | 
 |  | 
 | @node Reporting Bugs | 
 | @chapter Reporting Bugs | 
 | @cindex bugs in @command{ld} | 
 | @cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld} | 
 |  | 
 | Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable. | 
 |  | 
 | Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or | 
 | it may not.  But in any case the principal function of a bug report is | 
 | to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld} | 
 | work better.  Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of | 
 | @command{ld}. | 
 |  | 
 | In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the | 
 | information that enables us to fix the bug. | 
 |  | 
 | @menu | 
 | * Bug Criteria::                Have you found a bug? | 
 | * Bug Reporting::               How to report bugs | 
 | @end menu | 
 |  | 
 | @node Bug Criteria | 
 | @section Have You Found a Bug? | 
 | @cindex bug criteria | 
 |  | 
 | If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize @bullet | 
 | @cindex fatal signal | 
 | @cindex linker crash | 
 | @cindex crash of linker | 
 | @item | 
 | If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a | 
 | @command{ld} bug.  Reliable linkers never crash. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex error on valid input | 
 | @item | 
 | If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex invalid input | 
 | @item | 
 | If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that | 
 | may be a bug.  In the general case, the linker can not verify that | 
 | object files are correct. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for | 
 | improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case. | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | @node Bug Reporting | 
 | @section How to Report Bugs | 
 | @cindex bug reports | 
 | @cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting | 
 |  | 
 | A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} | 
 | products.  If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we | 
 | recommend you contact that organization first. | 
 |  | 
 | You can find contact information for many support companies and | 
 | individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs | 
 | distribution. | 
 |  | 
 | @ifset BUGURL | 
 | Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to | 
 | @value{BUGURL}. | 
 | @end ifset | 
 |  | 
 | The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this: | 
 | @strong{report all the facts}.  If you are not sure whether to state a | 
 | fact or leave it out, state it! | 
 |  | 
 | Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the | 
 | problem and assume that some details do not matter.  Thus, you might | 
 | assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not | 
 | matter.  Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure.  Perhaps | 
 | the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the | 
 | location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name | 
 | were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker | 
 | into doing the right thing despite the bug.  Play it safe and give a | 
 | specific, complete example.  That is the easiest thing for you to do, | 
 | and the most helpful. | 
 |  | 
 | Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix | 
 | the bug if it is new to us.  Therefore, always write your bug reports | 
 | on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously. | 
 |  | 
 | Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a | 
 | bell?''  This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless.  We | 
 | respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate. | 
 | You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with. | 
 |  | 
 | To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize @bullet | 
 | @item | 
 | The version of @command{ld}.  @command{ld} announces it if you start it with | 
 | the @samp{--version} argument. | 
 |  | 
 | Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for | 
 | the bug in the current version of @command{ld}. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any | 
 | patches made to the @code{BFD} library. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and | 
 | version number. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g. | 
 | ``@code{gcc-2.7}''. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and | 
 | observe the bug.  To guarantee you will not omit something important, | 
 | list them all.  A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is | 
 | sufficient. | 
 |  | 
 | If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong | 
 | and then we might not encounter the bug. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the | 
 | bug.  It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files | 
 | provided that they are reasonably small.  Say no more than 10K.  For | 
 | bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else | 
 | state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever | 
 | requests them.  (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so | 
 | we do not want to clog it up with large attachments).  But small | 
 | attachments are best. | 
 |  | 
 | If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using | 
 | @code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the | 
 | object files.  In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of | 
 | @code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files.  Also say | 
 | how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is | 
 | incorrect.  For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.'' | 
 |  | 
 | Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we | 
 | will certainly notice it.  But if the bug is incorrect output, we might | 
 | not notice unless it is glaringly wrong.  You might as well not give us | 
 | a chance to make a mistake. | 
 |  | 
 | Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still | 
 | say so explicitly.  Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your | 
 | copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the | 
 | C library on your system.  (This has happened!)  Your copy might crash | 
 | and ours would not.  If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours | 
 | fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us.  If | 
 | you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw | 
 | any conclusion from our observations. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context | 
 | diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or | 
 | @samp{-p} option.  Always send diffs from the old file to the new file. | 
 | If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by | 
 | context, not by line number. | 
 |  | 
 | The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your | 
 | sources.  Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us. | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | Here are some things that are not necessary: | 
 |  | 
 | @itemize @bullet | 
 | @item | 
 | A description of the envelope of the bug. | 
 |  | 
 | Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating | 
 | which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which | 
 | changes will not affect it. | 
 |  | 
 | This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we | 
 | will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger | 
 | with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples. | 
 | We recommend that you save your time for something else. | 
 |  | 
 | Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead} | 
 | of the original one, that is a convenience for us.  Errors in the | 
 | output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take | 
 | less time, and so on. | 
 |  | 
 | However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this, | 
 | report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | A patch for the bug. | 
 |  | 
 | A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one.  But do not omit | 
 | the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that | 
 | a patch is all we need.  We might see problems with your patch and decide | 
 | to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all. | 
 |  | 
 | Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to | 
 | construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path | 
 | through the code.  If you do not send us the example, we will not be | 
 | able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is | 
 | fixed. | 
 |  | 
 | And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your | 
 | patch should be an improvement, we will not install it.  A test case will | 
 | help us to understand. | 
 |  | 
 | @item | 
 | A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on. | 
 |  | 
 | Such guesses are usually wrong.  Even we cannot guess right about such | 
 | things without first using the debugger to find the facts. | 
 | @end itemize | 
 |  | 
 | @node MRI | 
 | @appendix MRI Compatible Script Files | 
 | @cindex MRI compatibility | 
 | To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI | 
 | linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an | 
 | alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language | 
 | described in @ref{Scripts}.  MRI compatible linker scripts have a much | 
 | simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with | 
 | @command{ld}.  @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI | 
 | linker commands; these commands are described here. | 
 |  | 
 | In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object | 
 | file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some | 
 | features to make use of them. | 
 |  | 
 | You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the | 
 | @samp{-c} command-line option. | 
 |  | 
 | Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each | 
 | command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though | 
 | blank lines are also allowed for punctuation).  If a line of an | 
 | MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld} | 
 | issues a warning message, but continues processing the script. | 
 |  | 
 | Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments. | 
 |  | 
 | You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all | 
 | lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}. | 
 | The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command. | 
 |  | 
 | @table @code | 
 | @cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI) | 
 | @item ABSOLUTE @var{secname} | 
 | @itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname} | 
 | Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all | 
 | the input files.  However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the | 
 | @code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in | 
 | your output program.  If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a | 
 | script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE} | 
 | commands will appear in the linker output.  You can still use other | 
 | input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using | 
 | @code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI) | 
 | @item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname} | 
 | Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname} | 
 | in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file. | 
 |  | 
 | @var{in-secname} may be an integer. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI) | 
 | @item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression} | 
 | Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}.  The | 
 | @var{expression} should be a power of two. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @code{BASE} (MRI) | 
 | @item BASE @var{expression} | 
 | Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than | 
 | absolute addresses) in the output file. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI) | 
 | @item CHIP @var{expression} | 
 | @itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression} | 
 | This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @code{END} (MRI) | 
 | @item END | 
 | This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI) | 
 | @item FORMAT @var{output-format} | 
 | Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker | 
 | language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S} | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @code{LIST} (MRI) | 
 | @item LIST @var{anything}@dots{} | 
 | Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the | 
 | @command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}. | 
 |  | 
 | The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the | 
 | same line, with no change in its effect. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI) | 
 | @item LOAD @var{filename} | 
 | @itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename} | 
 | Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the | 
 | same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld} | 
 | command line. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @code{NAME} (MRI) | 
 | @item NAME @var{output-name} | 
 | @var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the | 
 | MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line | 
 | option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI) | 
 | @item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname} | 
 | @itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname} | 
 | Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the | 
 | order in which they first appear in the input files.  In an MRI-compatible | 
 | script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command.  The | 
 | sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output | 
 | file, in the order specified. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI) | 
 | @item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression} | 
 | @itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression} | 
 | @itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression} | 
 | Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol | 
 | @var{name} used in the linker input files. | 
 |  | 
 | @cindex @code{SECT} (MRI) | 
 | @item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression} | 
 | @itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression} | 
 | @itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression} | 
 | You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to | 
 | specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}. | 
 | If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same | 
 | @var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address. | 
 | @end table | 
 |  | 
 | @node GNU Free Documentation License | 
 | @appendix GNU Free Documentation License | 
 | @include fdl.texi | 
 |  | 
 | @node LD Index | 
 | @unnumbered LD Index | 
 |  | 
 | @printindex cp | 
 |  | 
 | @tex | 
 | % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo.  In the | 
 | % meantime: | 
 | \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill | 
 | \centerline{The body of this manual is set in} | 
 | \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,} | 
 | \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}} | 
 | \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.} | 
 | \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and} | 
 | \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}} | 
 | \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill} | 
 | \page\colophon | 
 | % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91. | 
 | @end tex | 
 |  | 
 | @bye |